3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5 @set VERSION 7.9.3e (GNU Emacs 24.3)
7 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
8 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
9 @set txicodequoteundirected
10 @set txicodequotebacktick
12 @c Version and Contact Info
13 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
14 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
15 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
17 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
22 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
24 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
25 @c =======================================
27 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
28 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
32 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
34 @c orgkey{key} A key item
35 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
36 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
37 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
38 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
39 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
40 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
41 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
42 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
43 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
46 @c a key but no command
58 @c one key with a command
59 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
60 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
77 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
78 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
79 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
96 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
97 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
98 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
113 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
114 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
115 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
132 @c two keys with one command
133 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
134 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
149 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
153 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
155 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
156 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
157 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
164 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
168 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
179 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
180 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
181 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
196 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
200 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
201 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
202 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
217 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
221 @c two keys with two commands
222 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
223 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
224 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
231 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
232 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
235 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
236 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
246 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
249 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
252 @c Subheadings inside a table.
253 @macro tsubheading{text}
255 @subsubheading \text\
263 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
265 Copyright @copyright{} 2004--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
268 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
269 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
270 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
271 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
272 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
273 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
275 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
276 modify this GNU manual.''
280 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
282 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
286 @title The Org Manual
288 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
289 @author by Carsten Dominik
290 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
292 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
294 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
298 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
302 @c FIXME These hand-written next,prev,up node pointers make editing a lot
303 @c harder. There should be no need for them, makeinfo can do it
304 @c automatically for any document with a normal structure.
305 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
312 * Introduction:: Getting started
313 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
314 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
315 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
316 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
317 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
318 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
319 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
320 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
321 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
322 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
323 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
324 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
325 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
326 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
327 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
328 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
329 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
330 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
331 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
332 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
333 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
334 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
337 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
341 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
342 * Installation:: Installing Org
343 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
344 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
345 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
349 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
350 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
351 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
352 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
353 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
354 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
355 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
356 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
357 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
358 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
359 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
363 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
364 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
365 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
366 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
367 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
368 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
372 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
373 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
374 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
375 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
376 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
377 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
378 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
379 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
380 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
384 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
385 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
386 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
387 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
388 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
389 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
390 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
391 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
395 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
399 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
400 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
401 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
402 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
403 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
404 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
406 Extended use of TODO keywords
408 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
409 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
410 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
411 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
412 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
413 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
414 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
418 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
419 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
420 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
424 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
425 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
426 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
428 Properties and columns
430 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
431 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
432 * Property searches:: Matching property values
433 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
434 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
435 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
439 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
440 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
441 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
445 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
446 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
450 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
451 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
452 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
453 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
454 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
455 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
456 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
460 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
461 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
463 Deadlines and scheduling
465 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
466 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
470 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
471 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
472 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
474 Capture - Refile - Archive
476 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
477 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
478 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
479 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
480 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
481 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
485 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
486 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
487 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
491 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
492 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
493 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
497 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
498 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
502 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
503 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
504 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
505 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
506 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
507 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
508 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
509 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
511 The built-in agenda views
513 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
514 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
515 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
516 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
517 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
518 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
520 Presentation and sorting
522 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
523 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
524 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
528 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
529 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
530 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
532 Markup for rich export
534 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
535 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
536 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
537 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
538 * Index entries:: Making an index
539 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
540 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
542 Structural markup elements
544 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
545 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
546 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
547 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
549 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
550 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
551 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
552 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
553 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
557 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
558 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
559 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
560 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
561 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
565 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
566 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
567 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
568 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
569 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
570 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
571 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
572 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
573 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
574 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
575 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
576 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
580 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
581 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
582 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
583 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
584 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
585 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
586 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
587 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
588 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
589 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
591 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
593 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
594 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
595 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
596 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
597 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
598 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
602 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
603 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
604 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
605 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
606 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
607 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
609 OpenDocument Text export
611 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
612 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
613 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
614 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
615 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
616 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
617 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
618 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
619 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
620 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
621 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
623 Math formatting in ODT export
625 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
626 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
628 Advanced topics in ODT export
630 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
631 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
632 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
633 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
634 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
638 * Configuration:: Defining projects
639 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
640 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
641 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
645 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
646 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
647 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
648 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
649 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
650 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
651 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
652 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
656 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
657 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
659 Working with source code
661 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
662 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
663 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
664 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
665 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
666 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
667 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
668 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
669 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
670 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
671 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
672 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
676 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
677 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
679 Using header arguments
681 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
682 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
683 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
684 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
685 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
686 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
688 Specific header arguments
690 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
691 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
692 be collected and handled
693 * file:: Specify a path for file output
694 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
695 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
696 directory for code block execution
697 * exports:: Export code and/or results
698 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
699 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
700 files during tangling
701 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
703 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
705 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
706 expansion during tangling
707 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
708 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
709 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
710 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
711 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
712 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
713 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
714 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
715 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
716 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
717 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
718 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
722 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
723 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
724 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
725 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
726 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
727 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
728 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
729 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
730 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
731 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
732 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
734 Interaction with other packages
736 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
737 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
741 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
742 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
743 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
744 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
745 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
746 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
747 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
748 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
749 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
750 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
752 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
754 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
755 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
756 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
757 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
761 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
762 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
763 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
768 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
769 @chapter Introduction
773 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
774 * Installation:: Installing Org
775 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
776 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
777 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
780 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
784 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
785 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
787 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
788 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
789 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
790 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
791 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
792 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
793 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
794 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
795 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
796 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
797 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
798 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
799 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
802 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
803 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
804 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
806 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
807 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
808 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
810 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
811 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
812 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
813 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
814 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
815 the minor Orgstruct mode.
817 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
818 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
819 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
820 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
824 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
825 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
826 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
827 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
828 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
829 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
830 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
831 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
832 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
836 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
837 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
838 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
839 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
841 @cindex print edition
842 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
843 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
849 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
850 @section Installation
854 Org is part of recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you normally don't need
855 to install it. If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top
856 of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it:
859 @item By using Emacs package system.
860 @item By downloading Org as an archive.
861 @item By using Org's git repository.
864 We @b{strongly recommend} to stick to a single installation method.
866 @subsubheading Using Emacs packaging system
868 Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you install
869 Elisp libraries. You can install Org with @kbd{M-x package-install RET org}.
870 To make sure your Org configuration is well taken into account, initialize
871 the package system with @code{(package-initialize)} before setting any Org
872 option. If you want to use Org's package repository, check out the
873 @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}.
875 @subsubheading Downloading Org as an archive
877 You can download Org latest release from @uref{http://orgmode.org/, Org's
878 website}. In this case, make sure you set the load-path correctly in your
882 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
885 The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not included
886 in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the @file{contrib} directory to your
890 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
893 Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your system.
894 Run @code{make help} to list compilation and installation options.
896 @subsubheading Using Org's git repository
898 You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this:
902 $ git clone git://orgmode.org/org-mode.git
906 Note that in this case, @code{make autoloads} is mandatory: it defines Org's
907 version in @file{org-version.el} and Org's autoloads in
908 @file{org-loaddefs.el}.
910 Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method above.
912 You can also compile with @code{make}, generate the documentation with
913 @code{make doc}, create a local configuration with @code{make config} and
914 install Org with @code{make install}. Please run @code{make help} to get
915 the list of compilation/installation options.
917 For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the Org
918 Build System page on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html,
921 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
926 @cindex global key bindings
927 @cindex key bindings, global
930 @findex org-store-link
933 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
934 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
938 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
941 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in
942 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
943 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
945 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
946 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
948 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
949 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
950 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
951 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
954 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
955 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
956 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
957 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
960 @cindex Org mode, turning on
961 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
962 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
966 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
969 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
970 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
971 the file's name is. See also the variable
972 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
974 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
975 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
976 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
977 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
979 (transient-mark-mode 1)
981 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
982 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
983 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
985 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
992 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
993 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
994 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
995 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
996 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
997 moderators have to do.}.
999 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1000 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1001 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1002 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1003 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1004 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1005 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1007 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1009 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1010 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1011 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1013 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1014 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1015 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1016 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1017 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1020 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1023 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1024 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1025 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1029 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1031 ;; activate debugging
1032 (setq debug-on-error t
1036 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1037 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1038 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1041 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1042 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1046 @item What exactly did you do?
1047 @item What did you expect to happen?
1048 @item What happened instead?
1050 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1052 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1054 @cindex backtrace of an error
1055 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1056 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1057 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1058 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1059 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1063 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1064 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1067 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1070 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1073 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1074 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1076 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1077 document the steps you take.
1079 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1080 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1081 attach it to your bug report.
1084 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1085 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1087 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1089 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1090 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1095 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1099 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1100 meaning are written with all capitals.
1103 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1104 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1107 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1108 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1109 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1110 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1111 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1114 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1120 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1121 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1122 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1124 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1125 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1126 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1127 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1128 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1129 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1130 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1131 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1132 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1133 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1135 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1136 @chapter Document structure
1137 @cindex document structure
1138 @cindex structure of document
1140 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1141 edit the structure of the document.
1144 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1145 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1146 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1147 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1148 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1149 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1150 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1151 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1152 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1153 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1154 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1157 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1160 @cindex Outline mode
1162 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1163 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1164 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1165 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1166 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1167 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1168 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1169 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1171 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1174 @cindex outline tree
1175 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1176 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1177 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1179 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1180 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1181 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1182 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1183 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1184 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1187 * Top level headline
1194 * Another top level headline
1197 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1198 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1199 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1201 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1202 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1203 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1204 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1205 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1206 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1208 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1209 @section Visibility cycling
1210 @cindex cycling, visibility
1211 @cindex visibility cycling
1212 @cindex trees, visibility
1213 @cindex show hidden text
1216 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1217 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1218 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1220 @cindex subtree visibility states
1221 @cindex subtree cycling
1222 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1223 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1224 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1226 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1227 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1230 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1231 '-----------------------------------'
1234 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1235 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1236 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1237 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1238 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1239 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1240 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1241 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1243 @cindex global visibility states
1244 @cindex global cycling
1245 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1246 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1247 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1248 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1249 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1250 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1253 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1254 '--------------------------------------'
1257 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1258 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1259 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1261 @cindex show all, command
1262 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1263 Show all, including drawers.
1264 @cindex revealing context
1265 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1266 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1267 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1268 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1269 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1270 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1271 entire subtree of the parent.
1272 @cindex show branches, command
1273 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1274 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1275 @cindex show children, command
1276 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1277 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1278 expose all children down to level N@.
1279 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1280 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1283 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1286 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1288 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1289 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1290 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1291 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1292 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1293 the previously used indirect buffer.
1294 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1295 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1298 @vindex org-startup-folded
1299 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1300 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1301 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1302 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1304 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1305 OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1306 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1307 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1314 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1317 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1319 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1320 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1321 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1324 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1325 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1326 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1330 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1332 @cindex motion, between headlines
1333 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1334 @cindex headline navigation
1335 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1338 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1340 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1342 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1343 Next heading same level.
1344 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1345 Previous heading same level.
1346 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1347 Backward to higher level heading.
1348 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1349 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1350 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1351 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1352 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1354 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1355 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1356 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1357 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1358 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1359 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1360 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1362 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1365 @vindex org-goto-interface
1367 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1370 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1371 @section Structure editing
1372 @cindex structure editing
1373 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1374 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1375 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1376 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1377 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1378 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1379 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1380 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1381 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1384 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1385 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1386 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1387 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1388 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1389 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1390 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1391 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1392 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1393 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1394 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.,
1395 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1396 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1397 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1398 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1399 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1400 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1401 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1402 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1403 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1404 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1405 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1406 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1407 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1409 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1410 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1411 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1412 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1413 to the initial level.
1414 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1415 Promote current heading by one level.
1416 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1417 Demote current heading by one level.
1418 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1419 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1420 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1421 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1422 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1423 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1425 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1426 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1427 @orgcmd{M-h,org-mark-element}
1428 Mark the element at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent elements
1429 of the one just marked. E.g. hitting @key{M-h} on a paragraph will mark it,
1430 hitting @key{M-h} immediately again will mark the next one.
1431 @orgcmd{C-c @@,org-mark-subtree}
1432 Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent subtrees
1433 of the same level than the marked subtree.
1434 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1435 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1436 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1437 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1438 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1439 sequential subtrees.
1440 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1441 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1442 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1443 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1444 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1445 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1446 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1447 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1448 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1449 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1450 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1451 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1452 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1453 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1454 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1455 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1456 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1458 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1459 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1460 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1461 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1462 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1463 more details, see the docstring of the command
1464 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1465 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1466 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1467 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1468 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1469 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1470 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1471 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1472 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1473 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1474 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1475 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1476 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1477 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1478 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1479 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1480 Narrow buffer to current block.
1481 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1482 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1483 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1484 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1485 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1486 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1487 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1488 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1489 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1492 @cindex region, active
1493 @cindex active region
1494 @cindex transient mark mode
1495 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1496 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1497 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1498 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1499 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1500 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1504 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1505 @section Sparse trees
1506 @cindex sparse trees
1507 @cindex trees, sparse
1508 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1509 @cindex occur, command
1511 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1512 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1513 @vindex org-show-siblings
1514 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1515 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1516 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1517 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1518 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1519 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1520 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1521 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1522 and you will see immediately how it works.
1524 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1525 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1528 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1529 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1530 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1531 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1532 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1533 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1534 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1535 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1536 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1537 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1538 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1539 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1540 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1541 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1542 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1543 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1544 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1545 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1550 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1551 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1552 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1553 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1554 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1558 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1559 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1562 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1563 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1565 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1566 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1569 @cindex printing sparse trees
1570 @cindex visible text, printing
1571 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1572 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1573 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1574 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1575 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1576 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1578 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1579 @section Plain lists
1581 @cindex lists, plain
1582 @cindex lists, ordered
1583 @cindex ordered lists
1585 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1586 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1587 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1588 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1590 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1593 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1594 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1595 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1596 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1597 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1598 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1601 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1602 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1603 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1604 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1605 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1606 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1607 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1608 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1609 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1610 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1611 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1612 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1613 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1614 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1616 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1617 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1621 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1622 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1623 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1624 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1625 than its bullet/number.
1627 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1628 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1629 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1630 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1631 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1635 ** Lord of the Rings
1636 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1637 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1638 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1639 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1640 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1641 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1643 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1644 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1645 Important actors in this film are:
1646 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1647 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1648 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1652 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1653 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1654 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1655 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1656 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1657 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1658 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1660 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1661 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1662 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1663 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1664 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1665 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1666 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1668 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1669 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1670 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1671 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1672 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1673 to disable them individually.
1676 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1677 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1678 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1679 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1680 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1681 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1682 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1683 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1684 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1685 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1686 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1687 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1688 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1689 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1690 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1691 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1692 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1693 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1694 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1695 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1696 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1697 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1702 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1704 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1705 @kindex S-@key{down}
1708 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1709 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1710 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1711 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1712 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1713 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1714 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1715 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1718 @kindex M-@key{down}
1721 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1722 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1723 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1725 @kindex M-@key{left}
1726 @kindex M-@key{right}
1729 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1730 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1731 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1734 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1735 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1736 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1737 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1738 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1741 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1742 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1743 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1744 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1747 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1748 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1749 consistency in the whole list.
1751 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1753 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1754 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1755 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1756 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1757 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1758 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1759 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1760 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1761 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1764 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1765 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1768 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1769 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1771 @kindex S-@key{left}
1772 @kindex S-@key{right}
1774 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1775 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1776 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1777 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1780 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1781 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1784 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1788 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1791 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1793 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1794 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1795 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1796 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1797 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1801 ** This is a headline
1802 Still outside the drawer
1804 This is inside the drawer.
1809 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1810 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1811 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1812 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1813 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1814 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1816 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1817 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1818 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1819 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1820 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1821 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1822 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1823 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1828 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1831 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1834 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1835 @cindex blocks, folding
1836 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1837 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1838 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1839 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1840 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1841 or on a per-file basis by using
1843 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1844 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1846 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1847 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1850 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1854 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1855 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1856 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1857 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e., a footnote is
1858 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1859 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1860 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1861 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1864 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1866 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1869 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1870 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1871 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1872 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1873 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1877 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1878 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1881 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1882 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1883 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1884 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1886 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1887 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1888 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1889 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1892 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1893 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1894 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1895 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1898 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1903 The footnote action command.
1905 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1906 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1908 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1909 @vindex org-footnote-section
1910 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1911 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1912 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1913 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1914 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1915 separately into the location determined by the variable
1916 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1918 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1921 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1922 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1923 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1924 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1925 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1926 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1927 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1928 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1929 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1930 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1931 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1932 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1933 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1934 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g., sending}
1935 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1936 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1937 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1940 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1941 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1942 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1947 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1948 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1949 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1953 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1954 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1955 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1958 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1959 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1960 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1961 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1963 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1964 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1965 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1966 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1967 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1970 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1971 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1974 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1975 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1976 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1977 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1978 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1979 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1980 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1983 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1986 @cindex editing tables
1988 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1989 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1990 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1993 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1994 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1995 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1996 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1997 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1998 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2001 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2002 @section The built-in table editor
2003 @cindex table editor, built-in
2005 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2006 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2007 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2008 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2009 might look like this:
2012 | Name | Phone | Age |
2013 |-------+-------+-----|
2014 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2015 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2018 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2019 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2020 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2021 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2022 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2023 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2024 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2025 create the above table, you would only type
2032 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2033 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2034 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2036 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2037 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2038 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2039 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2040 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2041 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2042 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2043 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2044 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2045 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2048 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2049 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2050 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2051 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2052 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2053 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2054 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2055 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2056 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2058 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2059 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2060 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2062 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2063 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2064 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2066 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2067 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2070 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2071 Re-align, move to previous field.
2073 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2074 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2075 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2076 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2078 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2079 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2080 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2081 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2083 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2084 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2085 Move the current column left/right.
2087 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2088 Kill the current column.
2090 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2091 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2093 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2094 Move the current row up/down.
2096 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2097 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2099 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2100 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2101 created below the current one.
2103 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2104 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2105 is created above the current line.
2107 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2108 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2111 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2112 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2113 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2114 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2115 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2116 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2117 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2118 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2119 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2120 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2122 @tsubheading{Regions}
2123 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2124 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2125 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2126 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2128 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2129 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2130 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2132 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2133 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2134 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2135 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2136 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2139 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2140 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2141 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2142 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2143 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2144 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2145 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2148 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2149 @cindex formula, in tables
2150 @cindex calculations, in tables
2151 @cindex region, active
2152 @cindex active region
2153 @cindex transient mark mode
2154 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2155 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2156 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2157 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2159 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2160 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2161 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2162 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2163 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2164 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2165 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2166 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2167 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2169 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2170 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2171 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2172 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2173 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2174 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2175 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2176 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2177 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2179 @item M-x org-table-import
2180 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2181 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2182 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2183 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2184 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2185 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2187 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2188 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2189 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2190 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2192 @item M-x org-table-export
2193 @findex org-table-export
2194 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2195 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2196 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2197 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2198 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2199 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2200 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2201 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2202 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2203 detailed description.
2206 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2207 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2211 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2214 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2215 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2217 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2218 @section Column width and alignment
2219 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2220 @cindex alignment in tables
2222 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2223 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2224 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2226 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2227 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2228 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2229 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2230 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2231 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2232 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2236 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2238 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2239 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2240 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2241 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2242 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2247 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2248 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2249 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2250 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2251 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2252 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2255 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2256 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2257 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2258 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2259 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2260 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2261 on a per-file basis with:
2268 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2269 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2270 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2271 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2272 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2274 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2275 automatically when exporting the document.
2277 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2278 @section Column groups
2279 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2281 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2282 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2283 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2284 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2285 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2286 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2287 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2288 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2289 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2290 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2291 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2294 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2295 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2296 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2297 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2298 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2299 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2300 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2301 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2304 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2305 every vertical line you would like to have:
2308 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2309 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2313 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2314 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2316 @cindex minor mode for tables
2318 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2319 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2320 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2321 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2322 example in Message mode, use
2325 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2328 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2329 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2330 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2331 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2332 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2334 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2335 @section The spreadsheet
2336 @cindex calculations, in tables
2337 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2338 @cindex @file{calc} package
2340 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2341 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2342 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2343 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2344 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2345 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2346 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2347 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2348 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2351 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2352 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2353 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2354 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2355 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2356 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2357 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2358 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2359 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2362 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2363 @subsection References
2366 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2367 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2368 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2369 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2370 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2372 @subsubheading Field references
2373 @cindex field references
2374 @cindex references, to fields
2376 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2377 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2378 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2379 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2380 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2381 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2382 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2383 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2384 representation that looks like this:
2386 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2389 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2390 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2391 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2392 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2393 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2394 column from the right.
2396 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2397 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2398 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2399 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2400 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2401 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2402 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2403 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2404 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2405 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2406 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2407 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2408 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2409 after the third hline in the table.
2411 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2412 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2413 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2416 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2417 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2418 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2419 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2420 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2421 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2423 Here are a few examples:
2426 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2427 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2428 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2429 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2430 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2431 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2434 @subsubheading Range references
2435 @cindex range references
2436 @cindex references, to ranges
2438 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2439 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2440 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2441 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2442 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2443 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2446 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2447 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2448 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2449 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2450 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{in the first row up, 3 fields from 2 columns on the left}
2451 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2454 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2455 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2456 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2457 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2458 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2460 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2461 @cindex field coordinates
2462 @cindex coordinates, of field
2463 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2464 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2466 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2467 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2468 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2469 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2472 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2473 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2474 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2477 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2478 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2479 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2482 @subsubheading Named references
2483 @cindex named references
2484 @cindex references, named
2485 @cindex name, of column or field
2486 @cindex constants, in calculations
2489 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2490 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2491 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2492 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2496 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2500 @vindex constants-unit-system
2501 @pindex constants.el
2502 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2503 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2504 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2505 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2506 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2507 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2508 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2509 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2510 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2511 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2512 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2513 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2514 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2515 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2518 @subsubheading Remote references
2519 @cindex remote references
2520 @cindex references, remote
2521 @cindex references, to a different table
2522 @cindex name, of column or field
2523 @cindex constants, in calculations
2526 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2527 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2530 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2534 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2535 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2536 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2537 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2538 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2541 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2542 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2543 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2544 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2546 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2547 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2548 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2549 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2550 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2551 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2552 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2553 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2554 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2555 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2556 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2558 @cindex format specifier
2559 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2560 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2561 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2562 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2563 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2564 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2565 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2566 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2567 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2570 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2571 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2572 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2573 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2574 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2575 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2576 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2577 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2578 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2583 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2584 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2585 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2586 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2587 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2588 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2589 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2590 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2591 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2595 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2596 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2597 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2598 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2599 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2600 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2601 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2602 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2603 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2604 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2605 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2608 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2611 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2614 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2615 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2617 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2618 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2619 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2621 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2622 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2625 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2626 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2627 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2628 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2630 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2631 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2632 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2633 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2634 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2635 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2636 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2637 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2638 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2639 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2641 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2642 computations in Lisp:
2645 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2646 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2647 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2649 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1--4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2650 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2653 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2654 @subsection Durations and time values
2655 @cindex Duration, computing
2656 @cindex Time, computing
2657 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2659 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2660 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2664 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2665 |---------+----------+----------|
2666 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2667 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2668 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2672 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2673 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2674 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2675 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2676 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2677 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2680 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2681 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2683 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2684 @subsection Field and range formulas
2685 @cindex field formula
2686 @cindex range formula
2687 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2688 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2690 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2691 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2692 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2693 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2694 current field will be replaced with the result.
2697 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2698 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2699 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2700 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2701 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2702 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2703 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2704 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2705 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2706 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2707 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2709 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2713 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2714 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2715 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2716 it to the current field, and stores it.
2719 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2720 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2721 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2722 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2727 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2728 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2730 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2733 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2734 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2736 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2739 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2740 @subsection Column formulas
2741 @cindex column formula
2742 @cindex formula, for table column
2744 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2745 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2746 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2747 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2748 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2749 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2750 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2752 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2753 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2754 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2755 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2756 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2757 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2758 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2759 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2760 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2761 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2763 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2767 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2768 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2769 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2770 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2771 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2772 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2775 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2776 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2777 @cindex formula editing
2778 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2780 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2781 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2782 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2783 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2784 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2785 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2786 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2787 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2790 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2791 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2792 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2793 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2794 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2795 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2796 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2797 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2798 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2799 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2800 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2802 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2804 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2805 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2806 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2808 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2810 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2811 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2812 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2813 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2814 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2815 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2816 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2817 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2818 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2820 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2821 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2822 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2823 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2824 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2825 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2826 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2827 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2828 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2829 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2830 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2831 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2832 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2833 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2834 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2836 @kindex S-@key{down}
2837 @kindex S-@key{left}
2838 @kindex S-@key{right}
2839 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2840 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2841 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2842 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2843 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2844 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2845 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2846 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2847 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2848 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2850 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2851 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2853 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2855 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2859 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2860 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2861 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2862 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2863 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2866 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2867 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2868 recalculation commands in the table.
2870 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2871 @cindex formula debugging
2872 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2873 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2874 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2875 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2876 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2877 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2878 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2880 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2881 @subsection Updating the table
2882 @cindex recomputing table fields
2883 @cindex updating, table
2885 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2886 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2887 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2889 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2893 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2894 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2895 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2901 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2902 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2904 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2905 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2906 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2907 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2908 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2909 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2910 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2911 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2912 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2913 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2917 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2918 @subsection Advanced features
2920 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2921 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2922 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2923 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2924 special marking characters.
2927 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2928 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2929 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2930 change all marks in the region.
2933 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2934 makes use of these features:
2938 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2939 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2940 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2941 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2942 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2943 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2944 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2945 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2946 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2947 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2948 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
2949 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2950 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2951 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2952 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2956 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2957 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2958 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2959 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2962 @cindex marking characters, tables
2963 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2966 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2967 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2969 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2970 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2971 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2972 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2974 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2977 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2978 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2979 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2980 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2983 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2984 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2985 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2986 lines will be left alone by this command.
2988 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2989 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2990 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2992 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2993 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2996 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2997 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3000 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3001 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3002 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3007 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3008 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3009 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3010 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3011 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3012 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3013 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3014 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3015 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3016 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3017 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3021 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3023 @cindex graph, in tables
3024 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3027 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3028 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3029 @uref{http://xafs.org/BruceRavel/GnuplotMode}. To see this in action, ensure
3030 that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, then
3031 call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3035 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3036 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3037 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3038 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3039 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3040 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3041 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3042 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3046 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3047 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3048 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3049 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3050 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3051 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3053 @subsubheading Plot Options
3057 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3060 Specify the title of the plot.
3063 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3066 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3067 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3068 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3072 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3075 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3076 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3077 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3080 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3083 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3087 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3090 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3091 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3094 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3095 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3098 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3099 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3100 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3101 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3102 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3106 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3110 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3111 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3114 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3115 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3116 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3117 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3118 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3119 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3120 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3121 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3124 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3125 @section Link format
3127 @cindex format, of links
3129 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3130 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3133 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3137 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3138 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3139 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3140 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3141 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3142 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3143 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3144 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3147 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3148 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3149 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3150 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3151 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3152 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3153 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3155 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3156 @section Internal links
3157 @cindex internal links
3158 @cindex links, internal
3159 @cindex targets, for links
3161 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3162 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3163 current file. The most important case is a link like
3164 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3165 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3166 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3167 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3170 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3171 lead to a text search in the current file.
3173 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3174 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3175 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3176 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3177 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3178 comment line. For example
3184 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3185 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3186 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3187 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3190 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3191 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3192 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3193 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3194 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3195 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3196 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3198 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3199 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3200 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3204 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3207 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3208 @subsection Radio targets
3209 @cindex radio targets
3210 @cindex targets, radio
3211 @cindex links, radio targets
3213 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3214 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3215 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3216 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3217 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3218 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3219 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3220 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3221 cursor on or at a target.
3223 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3224 @section External links
3225 @cindex links, external
3226 @cindex external links
3227 @cindex links, external
3235 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3237 @cindex USENET links
3242 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3243 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3244 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3245 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3246 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3249 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3250 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3251 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3252 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3253 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3254 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3255 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3256 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3257 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3258 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3259 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3260 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3261 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3262 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3263 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3264 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3265 will be queried to create it.}
3266 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3267 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3268 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3269 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3270 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3271 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3272 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3273 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3274 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3275 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3276 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3277 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3278 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3279 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3280 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3281 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3282 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3283 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3284 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3285 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3286 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3287 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3288 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3289 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3290 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3291 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3294 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3296 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3297 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3298 format}), for example:
3301 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3305 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3306 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3307 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3309 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3311 @cindex square brackets, around links
3312 @cindex plain text external links
3313 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3314 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3315 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3316 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3318 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3319 @section Handling links
3320 @cindex links, handling
3322 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3323 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3326 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3327 @cindex storing links
3328 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3329 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3330 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3331 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3334 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3335 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3336 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3337 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3338 removed from the link and result in a wrong link---you should avoid putting
3339 timestamp in the headline.}.
3341 @vindex org-id-link-to-org-use-id
3342 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3343 @cindex property, ID
3344 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3345 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3346 @code{org-id-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will
3347 be created and/or used to construct a link@footnote{The library @code{org-id}
3348 must first be loaded, either through @code{org-customize} by enabling
3349 @code{id} in @code{org-modules} , or by adding @code{(require 'org-id)} in
3350 your @file{.emacs}.}. So using this command in Org
3351 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3352 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3353 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3356 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3357 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3358 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3359 constructed from the author and the subject.
3361 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3362 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3364 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3365 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3368 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3369 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3370 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3371 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3372 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3375 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3376 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3377 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3378 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3379 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3380 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3381 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3384 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3385 entry referenced by the current line.
3388 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3389 @cindex link completion
3390 @cindex completion, of links
3391 @cindex inserting links
3392 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3393 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3394 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3395 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3396 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3397 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3398 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3399 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3400 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3401 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3402 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3403 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3404 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3405 becomes the default description.
3407 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3408 All links stored during the
3409 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3410 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3412 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3413 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3414 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3415 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3416 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3417 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3418 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3419 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3420 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3422 @cindex file name completion
3423 @cindex completion, of file names
3424 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3425 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3426 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3427 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3428 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3429 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3430 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3431 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3433 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3434 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3435 link and description parts of the link.
3437 @cindex following links
3438 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3439 @vindex org-file-apps
3440 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3441 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3442 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3443 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3444 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3445 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3446 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3447 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3448 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3449 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3450 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3451 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3452 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3453 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3454 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3455 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3458 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3459 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3466 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3467 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3471 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3472 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3473 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3474 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3476 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3477 @cindex inlining images
3478 @cindex images, inlining
3479 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3480 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3481 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3482 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3483 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3484 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3485 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3486 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3487 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3488 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3489 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3491 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3492 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3494 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3495 @cindex links, returning to
3496 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3497 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3498 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3499 previously recorded positions.
3501 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3502 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3503 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3504 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3505 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3506 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3508 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3510 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3511 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3515 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3516 @section Using links outside Org
3518 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3519 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3520 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3524 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3525 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3528 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3529 @section Link abbreviations
3530 @cindex link abbreviations
3531 @cindex abbreviation, links
3533 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3534 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3535 abbreviated link looks like this
3538 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3542 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3543 where the tag is optional.
3544 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3545 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3546 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3547 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3551 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3552 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3553 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3554 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3555 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3556 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3557 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3561 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3562 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3563 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3564 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3565 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3567 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3568 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3570 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3571 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3573 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3574 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3575 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3576 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3577 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3578 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3579 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3581 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3582 can define them in the file with
3586 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3587 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3591 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3592 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3593 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
3594 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3595 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3597 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3598 @section Search options in file links
3599 @cindex search option in file links
3600 @cindex file links, searching
3602 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3603 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3604 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3605 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3606 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3607 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3608 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3609 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3611 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3612 link, together with an explanation:
3615 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3616 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3617 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3618 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3619 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3626 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3627 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3628 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3629 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3632 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3634 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3636 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3637 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3638 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3639 sparse tree with the matches.
3640 @c If the target file is a directory,
3641 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3644 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3645 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3646 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3647 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3649 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3650 @section Custom Searches
3651 @cindex custom search strings
3652 @cindex search strings, custom
3654 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3655 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3656 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3657 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3658 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3661 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3662 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3663 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3664 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3665 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3666 to be added to the hook variables
3667 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3668 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3669 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3670 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3671 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3673 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3677 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3678 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3679 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3680 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3681 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3682 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3683 item emerged is always present.
3685 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3686 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3687 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3690 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3691 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3692 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3693 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3694 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3695 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3698 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3699 @section Basic TODO functionality
3701 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3702 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3705 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3709 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3712 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3713 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3714 @vindex org-use-fast-todo-selection
3716 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3719 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3720 '--------------------------------'
3723 If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see @ref{Fast access to TODO
3724 states}), you will be prompted for a TODO keyword through the fast selection
3725 interface; this is the default behavior when
3726 @var{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is @code{non-nil}.
3728 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and agenda
3729 buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3731 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3732 When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific keyword using
3733 completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO states with no prompt. When
3734 @var{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is set to @code{prefix}, use the fast
3735 selection interface.
3737 @kindex S-@key{right}
3738 @kindex S-@key{left}
3739 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3740 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3741 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3742 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3743 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3744 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3745 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3746 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
3747 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3748 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3749 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3750 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3751 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3752 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3753 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3754 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3755 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3756 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3757 both un-done and done.
3758 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3759 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3760 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3761 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3762 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3763 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3764 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3765 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3769 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3770 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3771 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3773 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3774 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3775 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3777 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3778 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3779 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3780 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3781 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3784 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3785 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3788 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3789 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3790 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3791 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3792 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3793 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3794 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3797 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3798 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3799 @cindex TODO workflow
3800 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3802 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3803 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3804 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3808 (setq org-todo-keywords
3809 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3812 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3813 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3814 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3816 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3817 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3818 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
3819 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3820 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
3821 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3822 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3823 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3824 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3825 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3826 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3828 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3829 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3831 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3832 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3834 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3835 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3836 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3837 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3838 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3839 be set up like this:
3842 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3845 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3846 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3847 person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3848 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3849 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3850 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3851 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3852 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3853 to DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3854 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3855 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3856 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3857 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3858 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3860 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3861 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3862 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3864 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3865 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3866 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3867 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3868 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3872 (setq org-todo-keywords
3873 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3874 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3875 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3878 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3879 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3880 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3881 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3882 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3883 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3884 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3887 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3888 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3889 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3890 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3891 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3892 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3893 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3894 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3895 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3896 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3897 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3898 @kindex S-@key{right}
3899 @kindex S-@key{left}
3902 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3903 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3904 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3905 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3906 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3909 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3910 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3912 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3913 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3914 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3915 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3916 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3919 (setq org-todo-keywords
3920 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3921 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3922 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3925 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3926 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3927 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3928 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3929 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3930 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3931 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3932 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3934 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3935 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3936 @cindex keyword options
3937 @cindex per-file keywords
3942 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3943 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3944 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3945 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3946 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3950 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3952 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3953 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3955 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3958 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3962 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3966 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3968 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3969 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3971 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3972 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3973 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3974 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3975 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3976 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3977 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3978 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3979 for the current buffer.}.
3981 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3982 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3983 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3985 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3986 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3987 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3988 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3989 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3990 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3991 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3992 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3993 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3997 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3998 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3999 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4003 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4004 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4005 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4006 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4007 foreground or a background color.
4009 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4010 @subsection TODO dependencies
4011 @cindex TODO dependencies
4012 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4014 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4015 @cindex property, ORDERED
4016 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4017 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4018 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4019 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4020 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4021 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4022 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4023 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4024 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4028 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4037 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4038 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4042 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4043 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4044 @cindex property, ORDERED
4045 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4046 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4047 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4048 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4049 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4050 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4051 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4054 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4055 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4056 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4057 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4059 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4060 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4061 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4062 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4063 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4064 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4066 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4067 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4068 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4071 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4072 @section Progress logging
4073 @cindex progress logging
4074 @cindex logging, of progress
4076 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4077 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4078 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4079 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4080 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4084 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4085 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4086 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4089 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4090 @subsection Closing items
4092 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4093 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4094 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4097 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4101 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4102 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4103 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4104 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4105 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4106 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4109 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4113 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4114 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4116 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4117 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4118 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4119 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4121 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4122 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4123 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4125 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4126 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4127 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4128 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4129 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4130 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4131 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4132 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4133 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4134 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4135 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4136 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4137 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4138 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4139 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4140 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4142 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4143 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4144 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4145 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4149 (setq org-todo-keywords
4150 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4153 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4154 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4157 @vindex org-log-done
4158 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4159 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4160 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4161 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4162 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4163 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4164 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4165 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4166 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4167 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4168 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4169 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4170 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4171 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4172 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4175 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4178 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4181 @cindex property, LOGGING
4182 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4183 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4184 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4185 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4186 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4187 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4190 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4192 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4194 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4196 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4198 * TODO No logging at all
4204 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4205 @subsection Tracking your habits
4208 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4209 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4213 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4216 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4218 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4220 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4221 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4222 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4223 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4225 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4226 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4227 three days, but at most every two days.
4229 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4230 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4231 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4232 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4235 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4236 actual habit with some history:
4240 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4241 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4242 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4243 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4244 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4245 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4246 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4247 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4248 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4249 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4250 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4253 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4257 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4258 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4259 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4260 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4261 after four days have elapsed.
4263 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4264 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4265 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4266 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4270 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4272 If the task could have been done on that day.
4274 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4276 If the task was overdue on that day.
4279 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4280 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4281 the current day falls in the graph.
4283 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4284 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4287 @item org-habit-graph-column
4288 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4289 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4290 titles brief and to the point.
4291 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4292 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4293 @item org-habit-following-days
4294 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4295 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4296 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4300 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4301 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4302 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4303 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4305 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4309 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4310 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4311 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4314 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4318 @vindex org-priority-faces
4319 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4320 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4321 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4322 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4323 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4324 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4326 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4332 @findex org-priority
4333 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4334 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4335 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4336 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4337 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4339 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4340 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4341 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4342 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4343 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4344 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4345 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4348 @vindex org-highest-priority
4349 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4350 @vindex org-default-priority
4351 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4352 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4353 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4354 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4355 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4358 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4363 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4364 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4365 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4366 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4368 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4369 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4370 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4371 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4372 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4373 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4374 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4375 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4376 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4379 * Organize Party [33%]
4380 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4384 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4387 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4388 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4389 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4390 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4393 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4394 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4395 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4396 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4397 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4401 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4403 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4407 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4408 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4411 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4412 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4413 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4414 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4416 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4420 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4421 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4424 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4428 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4429 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4430 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4431 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4432 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4433 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4434 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4435 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4436 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4437 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4439 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4442 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4443 - [-] call people [1/3]
4448 - [ ] think about what music to play
4449 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4452 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4453 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4454 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4457 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4458 @cindex checkbox statistics
4459 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4460 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4461 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4462 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4463 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4464 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4465 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4466 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4467 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4468 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4469 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4470 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4471 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4472 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4473 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4474 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4475 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4476 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4477 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4479 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4480 @cindex checkbox blocking
4481 @cindex property, ORDERED
4482 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4483 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4484 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4486 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4489 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4490 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4491 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4492 one@footnote{@kbd{C-u C-c C-c} on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4493 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4494 considered to be an intermediate state.
4495 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4496 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4497 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4501 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4502 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4503 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4505 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4506 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4508 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4510 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4511 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4512 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4513 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4514 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4515 @cindex property, ORDERED
4516 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4517 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4518 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4519 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4520 for better visibility, customize the variable
4521 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4522 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4523 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4524 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4525 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4526 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4527 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4528 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4531 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4534 @cindex headline tagging
4535 @cindex matching, tags
4536 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4538 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4539 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4542 @vindex org-tag-faces
4543 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4544 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4545 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4546 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4547 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4548 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4549 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4550 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4553 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4554 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4555 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4558 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4559 @section Tag inheritance
4560 @cindex tag inheritance
4561 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4562 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4564 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4565 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4566 well. For example, in the list
4569 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4570 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4571 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4575 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4576 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4577 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4578 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4579 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4580 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4581 changes in the line.}:
4585 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4589 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4590 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4591 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, use @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4592 To turn it off entirely, use @code{org-use-tag-inheritance}.
4594 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4595 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4596 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4597 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4598 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4599 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4600 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4601 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4603 @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
4604 Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a tag,
4605 either in the @code{tags} or @code{tags-todo} agenda types. In other agenda
4606 types, @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} has no effect. Still, you may want to
4607 have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works fine,
4608 with inherited tags. Set @code{org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance} to control
4609 this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting this to nil
4610 can really speed up agenda generation.
4612 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4613 @section Setting tags
4614 @cindex setting tags
4615 @cindex tags, setting
4618 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4619 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4620 also a special command for inserting tags:
4623 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4624 @cindex completion, of tags
4625 @vindex org-tags-column
4626 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4627 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4628 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4629 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4630 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4631 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4632 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4633 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4634 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4637 @vindex org-tag-alist
4638 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4639 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4640 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4641 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4642 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4646 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4647 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4650 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4651 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4652 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4658 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4659 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4660 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4661 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4662 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4663 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4669 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4670 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4671 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4672 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4673 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4674 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4675 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4676 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4680 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4683 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4684 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4687 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4690 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4691 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4692 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4695 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4698 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4701 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4702 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4706 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4710 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4713 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4714 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4716 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4717 these lines to activate any changes.
4720 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4721 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4722 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4723 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4727 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4728 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4729 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4731 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4734 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4735 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4736 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4737 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4738 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4743 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4744 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4745 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4748 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4749 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4750 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4754 Clear all tags for this line.
4757 Accept the modified set.
4759 Abort without installing changes.
4761 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4763 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4764 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4766 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4767 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4772 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4773 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4774 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4775 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4776 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4777 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4778 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4779 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4781 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4782 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4783 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4784 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4785 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4786 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4787 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4788 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4789 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4790 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4791 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4793 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4794 @section Tag searches
4795 @cindex tag searches
4796 @cindex searching for tags
4798 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4799 information into special lists.
4802 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4803 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4804 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4805 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4806 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4807 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4808 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4809 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4810 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4811 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4812 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4815 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4816 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4817 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4818 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4819 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4820 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4821 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4824 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4825 @chapter Properties and columns
4828 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4829 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4830 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4832 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4833 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4834 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4835 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4836 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4837 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4838 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4839 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4840 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4842 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4843 (@pxref{Column view}).
4846 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4847 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4848 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4849 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4850 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4851 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4854 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4855 @section Property syntax
4856 @cindex property syntax
4857 @cindex drawer, for properties
4859 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4860 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4861 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4862 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4863 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4868 *** Goldberg Variations
4870 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4871 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4873 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4878 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4879 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4880 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4882 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4883 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4884 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4885 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4886 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4887 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4888 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4893 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4894 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4898 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4899 file, use a line like
4900 @cindex property, _ALL
4903 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4906 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4907 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4908 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4911 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4912 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4915 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4916 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4917 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4925 *** Goldberg Variations
4927 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4928 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4930 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4935 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4937 @vindex org-global-properties
4938 Property values set with the global variable
4939 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4943 The following commands help to work with properties:
4946 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4947 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4948 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4949 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4950 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4951 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4952 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4953 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4954 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4955 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4956 information like deadlines.
4957 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4958 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4959 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4960 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4961 can be inserted using completion.
4962 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4963 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4964 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4965 Remove a property from the current entry.
4966 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4967 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4968 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4969 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4970 nearest column format definition.
4973 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4974 @section Special properties
4975 @cindex properties, special
4977 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
4978 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
4979 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
4980 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
4981 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
4982 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4984 @cindex property, special, ID
4985 @cindex property, special, TODO
4986 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4987 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4988 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4989 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4990 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4991 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4992 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4993 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4994 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4995 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4996 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
4997 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4998 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4999 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5000 @cindex property, special, FILE
5002 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5003 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5004 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5005 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5006 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5007 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5008 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5009 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5010 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5011 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5012 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5013 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5014 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5015 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5016 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5017 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5018 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5019 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5020 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5021 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5024 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5025 @section Property searches
5026 @cindex properties, searching
5027 @cindex searching, of properties
5029 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5030 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5032 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
5033 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5034 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5035 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5036 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5037 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5038 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5039 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5040 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5041 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5042 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5045 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5048 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5053 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5054 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5055 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5056 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5057 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5060 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5061 @section Property Inheritance
5062 @cindex properties, inheritance
5063 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5065 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5066 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5067 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5068 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5069 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5070 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5071 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5072 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5073 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5074 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5075 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5076 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5077 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5079 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5080 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5082 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5085 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5086 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5087 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5088 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5089 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5091 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5092 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5093 applies to the entire subtree.
5095 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5096 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5097 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5099 @cindex property, LOGGING
5100 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5101 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5104 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5105 @section Column view
5107 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5108 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5109 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5110 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5111 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5112 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5113 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5114 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5115 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5116 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5117 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5118 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5119 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5122 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5123 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5124 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5127 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5128 @subsection Defining columns
5129 @cindex column view, for properties
5130 @cindex properties, column view
5132 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5133 done by defining a column format line.
5136 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5137 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5140 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5141 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5143 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5147 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5150 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5151 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5154 ** Top node for columns view
5156 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5160 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5161 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5162 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5163 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5164 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5165 deeper part of the tree.
5167 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5168 @subsubsection Column attributes
5169 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5170 definition looks like this:
5173 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5177 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5178 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5181 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5182 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5183 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5184 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5185 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5186 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5188 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5189 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5190 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5191 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5192 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5193 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5194 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5195 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5196 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5197 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5198 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5199 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5200 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5201 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5202 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5203 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5204 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5205 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5206 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5207 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5211 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5212 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5213 same summary information.
5215 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5216 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5217 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5218 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5219 1--10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5220 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5222 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5223 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5224 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5225 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5226 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5227 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5228 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5229 full job more realistically, at 10--15 days.
5231 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5235 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5236 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5237 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5238 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5239 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5243 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5244 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5245 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5246 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5247 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5248 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5249 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5250 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5251 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5252 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5253 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5254 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5255 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5256 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5259 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5260 @subsection Using column view
5263 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5264 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5265 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5266 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5267 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5268 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5269 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5270 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5271 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5272 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5273 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5274 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5275 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5276 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5277 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5279 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5281 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5282 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5283 Move through the column view from field to field.
5284 @kindex S-@key{left}
5285 @kindex S-@key{right}
5286 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5287 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5288 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5290 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5291 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5292 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5293 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5294 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5295 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5296 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5297 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5298 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5299 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5300 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5301 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5302 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5303 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5304 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5305 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5306 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5307 current column view.
5308 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5309 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5310 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5311 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5312 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5313 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5314 Delete the current column.
5317 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5318 @subsection Capturing column view
5320 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5321 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5322 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5323 of this block looks like this:
5325 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5328 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5333 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5337 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5338 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5339 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5340 capture, you can use 4 values:
5341 @cindex property, ID
5343 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5344 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5345 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5346 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5347 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5348 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5349 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5350 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5353 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5354 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5356 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5358 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5359 @item :skip-empty-rows
5360 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5361 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5366 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5369 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5370 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5371 for the scope or ID of the view.
5372 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5373 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5374 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5375 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5376 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5377 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5381 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5382 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5383 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5384 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5386 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5387 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5388 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5389 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5390 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5391 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5392 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5394 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5395 @section The Property API
5396 @cindex properties, API
5397 @cindex API, for properties
5399 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5400 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5401 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5404 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5405 @chapter Dates and times
5411 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5412 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5413 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5414 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5415 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5416 is used in a much wider sense.
5419 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5420 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5421 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5422 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5423 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5424 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5425 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5429 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5430 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5432 @cindex ranges, time
5437 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5438 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5439 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5440 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5441 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5442 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5443 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5444 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5445 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5446 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5449 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5452 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5453 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5454 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5455 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5458 * Meet Peter at the movies
5459 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5460 * Discussion on climate change
5461 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5464 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5465 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5466 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5467 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5468 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5469 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5472 * Pick up Sam at school
5473 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5476 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5477 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5478 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5479 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5480 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5481 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5482 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5483 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5484 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5485 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5486 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5487 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5488 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5489 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5490 example with optional time
5493 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5494 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5497 @item Time/Date range
5500 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5501 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5502 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5505 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5506 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5509 @item Inactive timestamp
5510 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5511 @cindex inactive timestamp
5512 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5513 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5514 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5517 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5523 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5524 @section Creating timestamps
5525 @cindex creating timestamps
5526 @cindex timestamps, creating
5528 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5529 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5533 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5534 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5535 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5536 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5537 succession, a time range is inserted.
5539 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5540 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5547 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5548 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5549 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5550 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5553 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5555 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5556 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5558 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5559 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5560 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5563 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5564 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5565 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5567 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5568 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5569 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5571 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5572 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5573 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5574 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5575 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5576 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5577 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5578 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5579 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5581 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5582 @cindex evaluate time range
5583 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5584 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5585 the following column).
5590 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5591 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5594 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5595 @subsection The date/time prompt
5596 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5597 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5599 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5600 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5601 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5602 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5603 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5604 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5605 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5606 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5607 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5608 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5609 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5610 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5611 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5612 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5613 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5614 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5615 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5616 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5618 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5619 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5623 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5624 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5625 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5626 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5627 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5628 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5629 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5630 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5631 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5632 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5633 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5634 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5635 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5636 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5639 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5640 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5641 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5642 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5643 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5644 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5645 the Nth such day, e.g.:
5650 +4d @result{} four days from today
5651 +4 @result{} same as above
5652 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5653 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5654 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5657 @vindex parse-time-months
5658 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5659 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5660 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5661 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5663 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5664 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5665 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5666 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5667 read the docstring of the variable
5668 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5670 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5671 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5672 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5676 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5677 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5678 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5681 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5682 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5683 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5684 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5685 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5686 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5687 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5688 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5689 from the minibuffer:
5696 @kindex S-@key{right}
5697 @kindex S-@key{left}
5698 @kindex S-@key{down}
5700 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5701 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5704 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5705 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5706 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5707 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5708 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5709 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5710 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5713 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5714 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5715 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5716 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5717 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5718 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5719 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5721 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5722 @subsection Custom time format
5723 @cindex custom date/time format
5724 @cindex time format, custom
5725 @cindex date format, custom
5727 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5728 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5729 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5730 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5731 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5732 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5733 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5736 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5737 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5741 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5742 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5743 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5744 following consequences:
5747 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5750 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5751 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5752 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5753 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5754 time will be changed by one minute.
5756 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5757 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5759 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5760 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5761 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5763 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5764 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5765 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5769 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5770 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5772 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5776 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5778 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5779 to be finished on that date.
5781 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5782 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5783 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5784 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5785 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5786 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
5789 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5790 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5791 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5794 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5795 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5796 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5799 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5801 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5804 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5805 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5806 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
5807 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5808 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5809 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
5810 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5813 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5814 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5818 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5819 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5820 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5821 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5822 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5823 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5824 want to start working on an action item.
5827 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5828 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5829 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5830 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5832 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5834 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5835 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5836 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5840 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5841 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5844 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5845 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5847 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5848 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5849 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5854 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5855 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5856 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5857 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5858 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5859 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5860 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5863 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5864 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5865 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5866 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5867 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5868 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5869 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5870 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5873 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5876 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5877 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5878 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5879 schedule the marked item.
5881 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5882 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5883 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5884 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5885 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5886 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5887 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5888 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5890 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5891 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5893 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5894 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5897 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5898 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
5899 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5900 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5902 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5903 @subsection Repeated tasks
5904 @cindex tasks, repeated
5905 @cindex repeated tasks
5907 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5908 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5909 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5911 ** TODO Pay the rent
5912 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5915 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5916 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5917 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5918 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5919 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5920 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5922 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5923 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5924 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5925 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5926 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5927 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5928 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5929 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5930 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5931 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5932 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5933 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5934 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5935 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5936 switch the date like this:
5939 ** TODO Pay the rent
5940 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5943 @vindex org-log-repeat
5944 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5945 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5946 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5947 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5948 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5950 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5951 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5954 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5955 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5956 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5957 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5958 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5959 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5960 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5961 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5962 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5966 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5967 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5968 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5969 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5970 and marked it done on Saturday.
5971 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5972 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5973 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5977 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5978 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5980 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5981 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5982 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5985 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5986 @section Clocking work time
5987 @cindex clocking time
5988 @cindex time clocking
5990 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5991 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
5992 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
5993 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
5994 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
5995 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
5996 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
5997 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
5998 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6000 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6002 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6003 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6005 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6006 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6007 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6008 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6012 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6013 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6014 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6017 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6018 @subsection Clocking commands
6021 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6022 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6023 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6024 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6025 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6026 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6027 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6028 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6029 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6030 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6031 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6032 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6033 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6034 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6035 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6036 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6037 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6038 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6039 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6040 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6041 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6042 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6043 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6044 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6045 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6046 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6047 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6048 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6049 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6050 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6051 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6052 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6053 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6054 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6055 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6056 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6058 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6059 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6060 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6061 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6062 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6063 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6064 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6065 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6066 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6067 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6068 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6069 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6070 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6071 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6073 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6074 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6077 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6078 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6079 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6080 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6081 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6082 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6083 clock duration keeps the same.
6084 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6085 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6086 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6087 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6088 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6089 increased by five minutes.
6090 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6091 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6092 if it is running in this same item.
6093 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6094 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6095 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6096 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6097 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6098 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6099 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6100 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6101 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6102 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6103 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6104 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6105 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6109 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6110 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6111 worked on or closed during a day.
6113 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6114 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6115 modify the window disposition.
6117 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6118 @subsection The clock table
6119 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6120 @cindex report, of clocked time
6122 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6123 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6124 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6127 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6128 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6129 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6130 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6131 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6132 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6133 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6134 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6135 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6136 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6137 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6138 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6139 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6140 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6141 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6142 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6143 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6147 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6148 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6150 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6152 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6156 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6157 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6158 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6159 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6161 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6164 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6165 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6166 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6167 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6168 file @r{the full current buffer}
6169 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6170 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6171 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6172 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6173 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6174 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6175 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6176 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6177 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6179 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6180 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6181 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6182 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6183 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6184 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6185 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6186 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6187 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6188 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6189 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6190 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6191 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6192 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6193 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6194 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6195 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6196 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6199 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6200 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6201 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6203 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6204 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6205 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6206 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6207 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6208 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6209 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6210 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6211 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6212 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6213 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6214 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6215 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6216 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6217 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6218 @r{property will get its own column.}
6219 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6220 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6221 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6222 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6223 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6224 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6226 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6227 day, you could write
6229 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6233 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6234 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6235 only to fit it into the manual.}
6237 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6238 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6241 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6243 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6246 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6249 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6253 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6254 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6256 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6257 @cindex resolve idle time
6259 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6260 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6261 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6262 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6263 applying it to another one.
6265 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6266 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6267 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6268 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6269 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6270 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6271 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same
6272 general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs
6273 idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will
6274 be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle
6275 time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a
6276 set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6280 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6281 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6282 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6284 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6285 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6286 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6288 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6289 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6291 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6292 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6293 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6295 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6296 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6297 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6298 log with an empty entry.
6301 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6302 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6303 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6304 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6305 the next task you clock in on.
6307 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6308 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6309 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6310 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6311 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6313 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6314 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6315 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6316 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6317 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6318 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6320 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6321 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6323 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6324 @cindex continuous clocking
6325 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6327 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6328 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6329 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6330 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6332 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6333 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6335 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6336 @section Effort estimates
6337 @cindex effort estimates
6339 @cindex property, Effort
6340 @vindex org-effort-property
6341 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6342 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6343 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6344 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6345 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6346 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6347 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6348 for an entry with the following commands:
6351 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6352 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6353 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6354 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6355 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6356 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6359 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6360 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6361 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6362 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6366 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6367 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6371 @vindex org-global-properties
6372 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6373 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6374 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6375 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6376 setup may be advised.
6378 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6379 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6380 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6381 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6383 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6384 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6385 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6386 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6387 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6388 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6389 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6390 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6391 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6393 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6394 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6395 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6396 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6398 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6399 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6400 @cindex relative timer
6402 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6403 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6404 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6407 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6408 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6409 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6411 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6412 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6413 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6414 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6415 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6417 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6420 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6421 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6422 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6423 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6425 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6426 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6427 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6428 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6429 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6430 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6431 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6432 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6433 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6434 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6435 not started at exactly the right moment.
6438 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6439 @section Countdown timer
6440 @cindex Countdown timer
6444 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6445 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6447 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6448 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6449 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6452 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6453 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6456 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6457 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6458 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6459 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6460 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6461 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6464 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6465 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6466 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6467 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6468 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6469 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6472 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6476 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6477 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6478 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6479 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6480 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6482 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6483 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6485 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6487 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6488 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6489 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6490 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6492 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6493 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6494 does enhance it with templates and more.
6497 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6498 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6499 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6502 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6503 @subsection Setting up capture
6505 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6506 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6507 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6509 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6511 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6512 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6515 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6516 @subsection Using capture
6519 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6520 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6521 not active by default: you need to install it. If you have templates
6523 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6524 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6525 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6526 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6528 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6529 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6530 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6531 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6532 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6534 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6535 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6536 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6537 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6538 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6539 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6540 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6542 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6543 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6547 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6548 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6549 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6550 rather than to the current date.
6552 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6557 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6558 template in the usual way.
6559 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6560 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6563 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6564 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6565 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6566 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6569 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6570 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6572 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6573 @subsection Capture templates
6574 @cindex templates, for Capture
6576 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6577 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6578 through the customize interface.
6582 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6585 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6586 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6587 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6588 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6589 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6593 (setq org-capture-templates
6594 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6595 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6596 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6597 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6600 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6604 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6608 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6609 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6610 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6611 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6612 place where you started the capture process.
6614 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6615 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6619 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6620 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6624 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6625 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6626 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6629 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6630 @subsubsection Template elements
6632 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6633 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6637 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6638 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6639 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6640 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6641 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6642 prefix key, for example
6644 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6646 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6647 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6650 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6654 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6657 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6658 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6660 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6661 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6663 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6666 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6667 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6668 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6670 Text to be inserted as it is.
6674 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6675 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6676 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6677 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6678 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6679 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6680 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6684 @item (file "path/to/file")
6685 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6687 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6688 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6690 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6691 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6693 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6694 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6696 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6697 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6699 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6700 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6702 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6703 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6705 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6706 A function to find the right location in the file.
6709 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6711 @item (function function-finding-location)
6712 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6717 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6718 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6719 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6720 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6721 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6725 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6726 Recognized properties are:
6729 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6730 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6731 Setting this property will change that.
6733 @item :immediate-finish
6734 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6735 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6736 information that can be added automatically.
6739 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6740 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6743 Start the clock in this item.
6746 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6749 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6750 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6751 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6752 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6755 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6756 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6758 @item :table-line-pos
6759 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6760 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6761 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6765 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6766 buffer again after capture is completed.
6770 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6771 @subsubsection Template expansion
6773 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6774 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6775 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6778 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6779 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6780 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6781 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6782 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6783 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6784 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6785 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6786 @r{region is active.}
6787 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6788 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6789 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6790 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6791 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6792 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6793 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6794 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6795 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6796 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6797 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6798 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6799 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6800 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6801 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6802 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6803 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6804 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6805 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6806 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6807 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6808 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6809 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6810 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6811 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6812 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6816 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6817 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6818 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6819 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6822 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6824 Link type | Available keywords
6825 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6826 bbdb | %:name %:company
6827 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6828 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6829 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6830 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6831 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6832 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6833 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6834 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6835 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6837 info | %:file %:node
6842 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6845 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6848 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6849 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6851 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6852 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6853 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6854 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6855 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6858 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6859 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6862 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6863 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6866 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6867 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6870 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6872 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6873 @section Attachments
6876 @vindex org-attach-directory
6877 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6878 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6879 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6880 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6881 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6882 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6883 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6884 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6885 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6886 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6887 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6888 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6889 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6891 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6892 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6893 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6896 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6900 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6901 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6902 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6903 to select a command:
6906 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6907 @vindex org-attach-method
6908 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6909 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6910 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6916 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6917 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6919 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6920 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6922 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6923 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6924 attachments yourself.
6926 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6927 @vindex org-file-apps
6928 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6929 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6930 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6931 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6933 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6934 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6936 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6937 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6939 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6940 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6942 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6943 Select and delete a single attachment.
6945 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6946 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6947 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6949 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6950 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6951 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6952 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6954 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6955 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6956 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6957 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6961 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6966 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6967 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6968 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6969 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6970 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6971 information. Here is just an example:
6974 (setq org-feed-alist
6976 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6977 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6981 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6982 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6983 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6984 the following command is used:
6987 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6989 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6991 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6992 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6995 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6996 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6997 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6998 list of drawers in that file:
7001 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7004 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7005 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7007 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7008 @section Protocols for external access
7009 @cindex protocols, for external access
7012 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7013 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7014 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7015 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7016 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7017 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7018 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7019 documentation and setup instructions.
7021 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7022 @section Refiling notes
7023 @cindex refiling notes
7025 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
7026 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
7027 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
7028 process, you can use the following special command:
7031 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7032 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7033 @vindex org-refile-targets
7034 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7035 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7036 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7037 @vindex org-log-refile
7038 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7039 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7040 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7041 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7042 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7044 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7045 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7046 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7047 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7048 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7049 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7050 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7051 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7052 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7053 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7054 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7055 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7056 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7057 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7058 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7059 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7061 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7062 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7063 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7064 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7065 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7068 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
7072 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7073 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7074 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7075 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7078 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7079 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7080 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7081 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7085 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7086 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7089 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7090 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7091 @cindex external archiving
7093 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7097 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7098 @vindex org-archive-location
7099 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7100 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7101 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7102 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7103 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7104 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7105 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7106 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7109 @cindex archive locations
7110 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7111 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7112 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7113 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7114 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7115 see the documentation string of the variable
7116 @code{org-archive-location}.
7118 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7119 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7120 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7121 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7122 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7123 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7124 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7125 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7129 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7132 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7134 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7135 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7136 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7138 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7139 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7140 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7141 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7142 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7146 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7147 @subsection Internal archiving
7149 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7150 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7152 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7153 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7156 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7157 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7158 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7159 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7160 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7161 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7163 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7164 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7165 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7166 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7168 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7169 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7170 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7171 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7172 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7173 temporarily included.
7175 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7176 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7177 is. Configure the details using the variable
7178 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7180 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7181 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7182 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7185 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7188 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7189 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7190 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7192 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7193 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7194 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7195 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7196 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7197 level 1 trees will be checked.
7198 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7199 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7200 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7201 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7202 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7203 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7204 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7209 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7210 @chapter Agenda views
7211 @cindex agenda views
7213 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7214 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7215 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7216 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7217 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7219 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7220 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7224 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7227 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7230 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7231 TODO state associated with them,
7233 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7234 in time-sorted view,
7236 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7237 that contain specified keywords,
7239 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7242 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7247 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7248 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7249 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7250 edit these files remotely.
7252 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7253 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7254 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7255 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7256 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7257 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7260 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7261 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7262 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7263 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7264 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7265 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7266 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7267 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7270 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7271 @section Agenda files
7272 @cindex agenda files
7273 @cindex files for agenda
7275 @vindex org-agenda-files
7276 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7277 files}, the files listed in the variable
7278 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7279 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7280 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7281 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7284 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7285 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7286 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7287 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7288 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7289 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7291 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7293 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7294 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7295 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7296 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7297 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7298 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7300 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7301 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7303 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7304 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7305 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7306 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7311 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7312 to visit any of them.
7314 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7315 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7316 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7317 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7318 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7319 extended period, use the following commands:
7322 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7323 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7324 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7325 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7326 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7327 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7328 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7329 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7330 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7334 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7337 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7338 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7339 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7340 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7342 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7343 Lift the restriction.
7346 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7347 @section The agenda dispatcher
7348 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7349 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7350 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7351 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7352 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7353 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7354 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7355 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7358 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7360 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7362 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7363 tags and properties}).
7365 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7367 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7368 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7370 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7371 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7372 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7373 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7374 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7377 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7379 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7380 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7381 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7382 selecting the command.
7384 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7385 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7386 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7387 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7388 character selecting the command.
7391 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7392 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7393 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7394 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7395 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7396 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7397 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7398 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7399 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7402 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7403 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7404 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7405 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7406 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7408 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7409 @section The built-in agenda views
7411 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7414 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7415 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7416 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7417 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7418 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7419 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7422 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7423 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7425 @cindex weekly agenda
7426 @cindex daily agenda
7428 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7429 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7432 @cindex org-agenda, command
7433 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7434 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7435 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7436 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7437 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7438 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7439 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7442 @vindex org-agenda-span
7443 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7444 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7445 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7446 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7447 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7450 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7451 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7452 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7455 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7456 @cindex calendar integration
7457 @cindex diary integration
7459 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7460 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7461 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7462 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7463 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7464 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7467 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7468 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7471 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7474 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7475 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7476 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7477 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7478 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7479 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7480 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7481 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7482 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7483 between calendar and agenda.
7485 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7486 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7487 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7488 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7489 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7490 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7491 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7492 will be made in the agenda:
7495 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7497 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7499 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7500 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7503 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7504 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7505 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7507 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7508 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7509 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7510 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7511 following to one of your agenda files:
7518 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7521 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7522 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7523 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7524 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7525 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7526 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7527 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7533 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7536 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7537 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7538 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7539 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7540 in an Org or Diary file.
7542 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7543 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7544 @cindex appointment reminders
7548 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7549 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7550 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7551 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7552 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7553 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7554 docstring for details.
7556 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7557 @subsection The global TODO list
7558 @cindex global TODO list
7559 @cindex TODO list, global
7561 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7562 collected into a single place.
7565 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7566 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7567 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7568 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7569 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7570 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7571 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7572 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7573 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7574 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7575 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7576 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7577 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7578 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7580 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7581 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7582 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7583 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7584 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7585 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7588 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7589 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7590 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7592 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7593 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7594 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7598 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7599 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7600 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7601 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7602 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7603 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7604 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7605 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7606 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7607 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7610 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7611 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7612 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7613 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7614 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7617 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7618 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7619 @cindex matching, of tags
7620 @cindex matching, of properties
7624 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7625 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7626 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7627 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7631 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7632 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7633 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7634 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7635 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7636 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7637 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7638 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7639 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7640 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7641 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7642 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7643 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7644 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7648 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7651 @subsubheading Match syntax
7653 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7654 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7655 OR@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7656 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7657 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7658 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7659 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7660 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7661 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7665 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7668 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7669 @item work|laptop+night
7670 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7674 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7675 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7676 braces. For example,
7677 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7678 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7680 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7681 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7682 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7683 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7684 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7685 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7686 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7687 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7688 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7689 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7690 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7691 DONE@. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7692 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7693 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7694 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7695 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7697 Here are more examples:
7699 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7700 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7701 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7702 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7703 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7706 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7707 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7710 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7711 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7715 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7718 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7719 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7720 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7722 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7723 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7725 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7726 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7727 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7728 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7729 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7730 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time
7731 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7732 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7733 respectively, can be used.
7735 If the comparison value is enclosed
7736 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7737 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7741 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7742 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7743 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7744 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7745 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7746 on or after October 11, 2008.
7748 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7749 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7750 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7753 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7754 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7755 inheritance}, for details.
7757 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7758 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7759 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7760 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7761 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7762 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7763 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
7764 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7765 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7766 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7767 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7768 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7772 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7773 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7774 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7776 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7777 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7781 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7782 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7783 @cindex timeline, single file
7784 @cindex time-sorted view
7786 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7787 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7788 to give an overview over events in a project.
7791 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7792 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7793 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7794 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7798 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7799 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7801 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7802 @subsection Search view
7805 @cindex searching, for text
7807 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7808 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7811 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7812 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7813 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7815 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7816 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7817 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7818 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7819 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7820 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7821 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7822 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7823 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7824 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7825 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7827 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7828 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7829 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7831 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7832 @subsection Stuck projects
7833 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7835 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7836 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7837 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7838 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7839 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7840 projects and define next actions for them.
7843 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7844 List projects that are stuck.
7847 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7848 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7849 project is and how to find it.
7852 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7853 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7854 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7855 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7857 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7858 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7859 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7860 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7861 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7862 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7863 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7864 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7865 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7866 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7867 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7868 correct customization for this is
7871 (setq org-stuck-projects
7872 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7876 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7877 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7879 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7880 @section Presentation and sorting
7881 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7883 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7884 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7885 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7886 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7887 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7888 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7889 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7890 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7891 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7892 associated with the item.
7895 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7896 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7897 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7900 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7901 @subsection Categories
7905 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7906 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7907 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7908 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7909 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7910 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7911 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7912 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7913 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7921 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7922 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7923 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7924 special category you want to apply as the value.
7927 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7928 longer than 10 characters.
7931 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7932 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7934 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7935 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7936 @cindex time-of-day specification
7938 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7939 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7940 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7941 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7943 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7945 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7946 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7947 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7948 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7950 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7951 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7952 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7955 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7956 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7957 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7958 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7962 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7963 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7966 8:00...... ------------------
7967 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7968 10:00...... ------------------
7969 12:00...... ------------------
7970 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7971 14:00...... ------------------
7972 16:00...... ------------------
7973 18:00...... ------------------
7974 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7975 20:00...... ------------------
7976 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7979 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7980 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7981 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7982 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7983 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7985 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7986 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7987 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7988 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7989 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7990 done depends on the type of view.
7993 @vindex org-agenda-files
7994 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7995 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7996 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7997 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7998 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7999 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8000 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8001 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8002 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8004 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8005 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8006 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8007 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8010 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8011 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8014 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8015 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8016 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8017 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8019 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8020 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8021 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8023 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8024 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8025 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8026 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8027 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8028 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8030 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8031 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8034 @tsubheading{Motion}
8035 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8036 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8037 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8038 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8039 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8040 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8041 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8042 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8043 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8044 outline, not only the heading.
8046 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8047 Display original location and recenter that window.
8049 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8050 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8052 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8053 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8055 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8056 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8057 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8058 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8059 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8060 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8061 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8063 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8064 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8065 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8066 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8067 previously used indirect buffer.
8069 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8070 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8071 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8072 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8074 @tsubheading{Change display}
8075 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8078 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8082 Delete other windows.
8084 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8085 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8086 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8087 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8088 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8089 @vindex org-agenda-span
8090 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8091 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8092 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8093 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8094 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8095 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8096 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8097 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8098 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8099 1938--2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8100 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8102 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8103 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8104 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8105 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8107 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8108 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8110 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8113 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8114 Prompt for a date and go there.
8116 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8117 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8119 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8120 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8122 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8124 @vindex org-log-done
8125 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8126 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8127 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8128 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8129 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8130 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8131 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8132 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8133 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8135 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8136 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8137 agenda and timeline views.
8139 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8140 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8141 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8142 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8143 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8144 press @kbd{v a} again.
8146 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8147 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8148 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8149 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8150 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8151 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8152 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8153 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8154 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8155 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8156 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8157 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8160 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8161 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8162 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8163 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8164 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8165 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8168 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8169 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8170 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8171 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8172 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8173 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8174 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8175 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8177 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8178 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8179 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8180 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8181 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8183 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8184 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8185 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8186 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8187 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8189 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8192 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8193 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8196 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8197 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8198 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8199 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8200 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8201 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8202 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8203 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8205 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8206 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8207 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8209 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8210 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8211 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8212 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8213 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8214 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8216 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8217 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8219 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8220 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8221 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8224 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8225 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8226 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8227 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8228 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8229 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8230 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8231 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8232 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8233 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8234 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8236 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8237 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8238 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8239 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8240 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8241 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8242 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8243 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8244 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8245 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8247 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8248 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8249 efforts globally, for example
8251 (setq org-global-properties
8252 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8254 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8255 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8256 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8257 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8258 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0--9 are not used
8259 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8260 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8261 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8262 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8263 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8265 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8266 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8267 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8268 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8269 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8270 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8271 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8272 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8273 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8277 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8279 ((string= tag "Net")
8280 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8281 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8282 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8283 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8284 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8287 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8291 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8292 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8293 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8294 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8295 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8304 @item @r{in} search view
8305 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8306 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8307 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8308 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8309 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8313 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8314 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8319 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8320 @cindex remote editing, undo
8321 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8322 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8323 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8325 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8326 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8329 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8330 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8331 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8333 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8334 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8335 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8336 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8337 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8338 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8340 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8341 Refile the entry at point.
8343 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8344 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8345 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8346 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8347 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8349 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8350 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8352 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8353 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8356 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8357 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8358 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8361 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8362 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8363 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8364 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8365 tags of a headline occasionally.
8367 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8368 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8369 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8373 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8374 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8375 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8377 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8378 Display weighted priority of current item.
8380 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8381 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8382 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8385 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8386 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8388 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8389 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8390 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8391 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8392 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8394 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8395 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8397 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8398 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8400 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8401 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8403 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8404 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8405 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8407 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8408 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8409 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8410 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8411 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8412 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8413 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8415 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8416 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8419 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8420 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8421 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8423 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8424 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8427 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8428 Stop the previously started clock.
8430 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8431 Cancel the currently running clock.
8433 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8434 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8436 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8437 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8438 the capture template. See @var{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8439 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8440 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8441 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8443 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8444 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8445 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8446 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8448 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8449 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8452 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8453 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8455 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8456 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8458 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8459 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8461 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8462 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8463 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8464 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8465 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8466 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8467 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8470 * @r{Toggle persistent marks.}
8471 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8472 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8473 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8474 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8475 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8476 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8477 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8478 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8479 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8480 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8481 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8482 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8483 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8484 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8485 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8486 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8487 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8489 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8490 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8491 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8492 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8493 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8494 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8495 @r{ (save-excursion}
8496 @r{ (save-restriction}
8498 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8499 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8500 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8504 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8505 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8507 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8508 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8510 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8511 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8514 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8515 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8516 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8517 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8518 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8519 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8520 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8521 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8522 you can add the entry.
8524 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8525 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8526 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8527 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8528 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8529 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8530 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8531 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8532 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8533 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8535 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8536 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8538 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8539 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8540 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8542 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8543 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8546 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8547 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8549 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8550 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8551 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8553 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8554 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8555 @cindex exporting agenda views
8556 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8557 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8558 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8559 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8560 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8561 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8562 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8563 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8564 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8566 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8567 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8568 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8570 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8571 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8572 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8573 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8574 visit Org files will not be removed.
8578 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8579 @section Custom agenda views
8580 @cindex custom agenda views
8581 @cindex agenda views, custom
8583 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8584 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8585 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8586 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8589 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8590 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8591 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8594 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8595 @subsection Storing searches
8597 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8598 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8599 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8602 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8603 @cindex agenda views, main example
8604 @cindex tags, as an agenda view
8605 @cindex todo, as an agenda view
8611 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8612 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8613 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8614 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8619 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8620 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8621 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8622 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8623 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8624 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8625 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8626 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8627 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8628 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8629 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8634 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8635 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8636 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8637 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8638 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8639 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8640 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8641 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8642 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8647 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8650 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8651 results as a sparse tree
8653 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8656 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8657 headlines that are also TODO items
8659 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8660 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8662 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8663 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8665 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8666 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8667 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8670 Note that the @code{*-tree} agenda views need to be called from an
8671 Org buffer as they operate on the current buffer only.
8673 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8674 @subsection Block agenda
8675 @cindex block agenda
8676 @cindex agenda, with block views
8678 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8679 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8680 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8681 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8682 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8683 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8684 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8688 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8689 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8693 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8701 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8702 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8703 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8704 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8705 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8707 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8708 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8709 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8711 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8712 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8713 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8714 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8715 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8716 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8717 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8721 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8722 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8723 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8724 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8725 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8726 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8727 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8729 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8730 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8735 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8736 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8737 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8738 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8739 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8740 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8741 to only a single file.
8743 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8744 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8745 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8746 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8747 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8748 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8749 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8750 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8751 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8752 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8753 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8757 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8758 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8762 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8763 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8764 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8771 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8772 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8773 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8774 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8775 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8778 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8779 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8780 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8781 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8782 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8786 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8787 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8790 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8791 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8794 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8795 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8798 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8800 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8801 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8802 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8804 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8805 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8806 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8807 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8808 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8809 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8810 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8813 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8814 @cindex exporting agenda views
8815 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8816 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8817 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8818 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8819 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8820 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8821 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8822 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8824 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8825 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8826 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8827 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8829 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8830 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8831 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8832 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8833 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8837 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8838 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8839 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8840 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8841 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8842 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8843 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8844 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8845 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8850 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8851 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8852 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8853 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8858 ("~/views/home.html"))
8859 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8864 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8868 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8869 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8870 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8871 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8872 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8873 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8874 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8875 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8877 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8878 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8879 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8883 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8884 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8888 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8889 set options for the export commands. For example:
8892 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8894 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8895 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8896 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8897 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8898 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8903 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8904 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8905 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8906 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8907 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8908 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8909 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8910 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8911 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8914 From the command line you may also use
8916 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8919 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8920 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8922 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8923 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8924 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8925 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8926 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8930 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8931 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8934 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8935 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8939 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8940 @section Using column view in the agenda
8941 @cindex column view, in agenda
8942 @cindex agenda, column view
8944 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8945 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8946 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8947 collected by certain criteria.
8950 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8951 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8954 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8955 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8956 This causes the following issues:
8960 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8961 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8962 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8963 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8964 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8965 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8966 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8967 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8968 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8969 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8971 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8972 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8973 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8974 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8975 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8976 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8977 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8978 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8979 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8980 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8981 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8982 some values will count double.
8984 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8985 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8986 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8987 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8988 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8989 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8990 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8994 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
8995 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
8996 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
8997 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
8998 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
8999 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9003 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9004 @chapter Markup for rich export
9006 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9007 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9008 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9009 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9010 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9013 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9014 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9015 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9016 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9017 * Index entries:: Making an index
9018 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9019 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9022 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9023 @section Structural markup elements
9026 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9027 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9028 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9029 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9031 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9032 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9033 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9034 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9035 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9038 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9039 @subheading Document title
9040 @cindex document title, markup rules
9043 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9047 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9051 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9052 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9053 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9054 title will be the file name without extension.
9056 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9057 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9058 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9059 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9061 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9062 @subheading Headings and sections
9063 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9065 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9066 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9067 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9068 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9069 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9070 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9071 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9072 per-file basis with a line
9079 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9080 @subheading Table of contents
9081 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9083 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9084 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9085 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9086 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9087 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9088 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9089 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9090 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9093 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9094 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9097 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9098 @subheading Text before the first headline
9099 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9102 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9103 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9104 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9105 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9107 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9108 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9109 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9110 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9111 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9112 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9115 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9116 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9120 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9121 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9122 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9125 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9127 @cindex lists, markup rules
9129 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9130 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9133 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9134 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9135 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9137 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9138 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9140 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9141 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9143 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9146 Great clouds overhead
9147 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9154 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9155 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9156 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9158 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9161 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9162 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9166 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9167 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9170 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9176 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9177 @subheading Footnote markup
9178 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9179 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9181 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9182 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9183 multiple footnotes side by side.
9185 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9186 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9188 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9189 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9190 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9191 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9192 @cindex code text, markup rules
9193 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9194 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9195 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9196 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9197 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9199 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9200 @subheading Horizontal rules
9201 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9202 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9203 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9205 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9206 @subheading Comment lines
9207 @cindex comment lines
9208 @cindex exporting, not
9209 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9211 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
9212 @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and will never be exported.
9213 Also entire subtrees starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be
9214 exported. Finally, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT}
9215 ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9220 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9224 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9225 @section Images and Tables
9227 @cindex tables, markup rules
9230 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9231 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9232 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9233 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9234 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9235 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9238 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9239 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9244 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9246 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9249 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9250 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9251 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9252 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9253 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9254 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9255 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9258 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9259 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9263 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9264 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9267 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9269 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9270 @section Literal examples
9271 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9272 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9274 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9275 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9276 for source code and similar examples.
9277 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9281 Some example from a text file.
9285 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9286 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9287 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9288 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9289 whitespace before the colon:
9293 : Some example from a text file.
9296 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9297 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9298 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9299 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9300 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9301 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9302 achieved using either the listings or the
9303 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9304 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9305 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9306 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9307 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9308 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9309 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9314 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9315 (defun org-xor (a b)
9321 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9322 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9323 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9324 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9325 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9326 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e., the reference name
9327 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9328 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9331 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9332 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9333 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9334 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9335 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9336 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9340 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9341 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9342 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9344 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9348 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9349 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9350 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9351 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9353 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9354 areas in HTML export}).
9356 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9357 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9358 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9363 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9364 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9365 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9366 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9367 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9368 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9369 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9370 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9371 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9372 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9373 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9374 will create a new fixed-width region.
9377 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9378 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9379 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9380 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9381 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9385 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9386 @section Include files
9387 @cindex include files, markup rules
9389 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9390 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9394 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9397 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g., @samp{quote},
9398 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9399 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9400 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9401 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9402 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9403 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9404 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9405 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9409 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9412 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9413 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9414 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9418 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9419 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9420 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9426 Visit the include file at point.
9429 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9430 @section Index entries
9431 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9433 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9434 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9435 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9436 an index} for more information.
9441 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9447 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9448 @section Macro replacement
9449 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9452 You can define text snippets with
9455 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9458 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9459 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9460 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9461 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9462 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9463 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9464 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9465 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9466 @code{format-time-string}.
9468 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9469 construct complex HTML code.
9472 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9473 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9474 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9475 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9477 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9478 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9479 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9480 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9481 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9482 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9483 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9484 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9485 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9488 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9489 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9490 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9491 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9492 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9495 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9496 @subsection Special symbols
9497 @cindex math symbols
9498 @cindex special symbols
9499 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9500 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9501 @cindex HTML entities
9502 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9504 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9505 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9506 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9507 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9508 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9509 delimiters, for example:
9512 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9515 @vindex org-entities
9516 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9517 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9518 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9519 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9520 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9521 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9523 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9524 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9525 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9526 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9527 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9529 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9530 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9531 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9532 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9537 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9538 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9539 for display purposes only.
9542 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9543 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9547 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9548 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9549 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9550 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9551 with curly braces. For example
9554 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9555 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9558 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9559 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9560 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9561 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9562 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9563 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9564 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9570 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9571 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9576 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9577 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9580 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9581 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9582 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9584 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9585 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9586 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9587 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9588 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9589 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9590 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9591 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9592 @file{MathJax} on your own
9593 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9594 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9595 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9596 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9597 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9598 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9599 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9600 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9603 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9604 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9607 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9608 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9609 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9610 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9611 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9613 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9614 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9615 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9616 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9617 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9618 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9619 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9622 @noindent For example:
9625 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9626 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9627 \end@{equation@} % etc
9629 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9630 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9634 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9635 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9636 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9637 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9639 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9640 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9641 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9642 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9643 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9647 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9648 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9649 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9650 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9653 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9654 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9655 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9657 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9658 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9663 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9664 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9665 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9666 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9667 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9668 process the entire buffer.
9671 Remove the overlay preview images.
9674 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9675 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9676 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9677 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9680 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9681 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9684 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9685 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9686 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9687 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9688 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9689 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9690 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9691 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9692 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9696 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9699 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9700 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9704 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9707 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9708 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9709 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9710 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9711 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9712 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9713 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9714 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9715 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9716 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9717 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9721 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9722 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9723 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9724 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9725 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9726 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9729 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9730 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9731 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9734 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9735 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9736 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9737 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9741 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9745 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9746 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9747 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9748 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9749 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9750 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9751 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9752 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9753 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9754 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9755 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9756 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9757 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9758 these different formats.
9760 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9761 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9764 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9765 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9766 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9767 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9768 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9769 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9770 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9771 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9772 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9773 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9774 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9775 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9778 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9779 @section Selective export
9780 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9782 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9783 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9784 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9785 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9786 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9787 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9788 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9792 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9793 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9794 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9795 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9798 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9802 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9803 be removed from the export buffer.
9806 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9807 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9808 variable for more information.
9810 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9811 @section Export options
9812 @cindex options, for export
9814 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9815 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9816 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9817 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9818 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9819 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9820 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9821 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9822 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9823 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9826 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9827 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9834 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9842 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9843 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9845 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9846 @vindex user-full-name
9847 @vindex user-mail-address
9848 @vindex org-export-default-language
9849 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9851 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9852 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9853 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9854 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9855 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9856 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9857 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g., @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9858 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9859 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9860 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9861 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g., @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9862 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9863 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9864 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9865 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9866 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9867 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9868 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9872 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9873 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9874 settings. Here you can:
9875 @cindex headline levels
9876 @cindex section-numbers
9877 @cindex table of contents
9878 @cindex line-break preservation
9879 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9880 @cindex fixed-width sections
9882 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9884 @cindex special strings
9885 @cindex emphasized text
9886 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9887 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9888 @cindex author info, in export
9889 @cindex time info, in export
9890 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9891 @vindex org-export-author-info
9892 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9893 @vindex org-export-email-info
9894 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9896 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9897 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9898 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9899 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9900 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9901 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9902 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9903 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9904 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9905 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9906 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9907 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9908 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9909 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9910 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9911 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9912 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9913 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9914 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9915 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9916 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9917 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9918 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9919 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9920 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9921 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9922 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9925 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9926 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9927 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9929 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9930 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9931 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9932 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9934 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9935 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9936 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9937 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9938 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9940 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9941 @section The export dispatcher
9942 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9944 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9945 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9946 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9947 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9948 the subtrees are exported.
9951 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9952 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9953 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9954 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9955 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9956 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9957 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9958 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9959 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9960 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9961 (i.e., not hidden by outline visibility).
9962 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9963 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9964 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9965 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e., request background processing if
9966 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9969 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9970 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9971 @cindex ASCII export
9972 @cindex Latin-1 export
9973 @cindex UTF-8 export
9975 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9976 file, containing only plain ASCII@. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9977 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9979 @cindex region, active
9980 @cindex active region
9981 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9983 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9984 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9985 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9986 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9987 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9988 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9989 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9990 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9991 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9992 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9994 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9995 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9996 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9997 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9998 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9999 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10000 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10001 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10002 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10003 Export only the visible part of the document.
10006 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10007 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10008 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10009 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10010 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10013 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10017 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10018 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10019 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10020 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10021 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10022 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10023 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10025 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10026 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10027 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10028 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10030 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10031 @section HTML export
10032 @cindex HTML export
10034 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10035 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10036 language, but with additional support for tables.
10039 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10040 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10041 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10042 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10043 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10044 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10045 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10046 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10047 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10048 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10051 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10052 @subsection HTML export commands
10054 @cindex region, active
10055 @cindex active region
10056 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10058 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10059 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10060 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10061 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10062 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10063 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10064 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10065 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10066 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10067 property, that name will be used for the export.
10068 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10069 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10070 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10071 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10072 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10073 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10074 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10075 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10076 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10077 Export only the visible part of the document.
10078 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10079 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10080 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10082 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10083 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10087 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10088 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10089 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10090 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10091 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10094 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10098 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10101 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10102 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10103 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10104 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10105 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10106 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10107 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10108 @vindex org-export-author-info
10109 @vindex org-export-email-info
10110 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10111 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10113 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10115 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10116 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10117 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10119 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10120 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10121 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10122 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10123 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10124 insert any preamble.
10126 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10127 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10128 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10129 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10130 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10131 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10132 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10133 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10134 insert any postamble.
10136 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10137 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10139 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
10140 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10141 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10142 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10143 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10144 the exported file use either
10147 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10149 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10153 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10157 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10162 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10163 @subsection Links in HTML export
10165 @cindex links, in HTML export
10166 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10167 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10168 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML@. This
10169 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10170 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10171 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10172 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10173 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10174 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10175 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10176 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10178 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10179 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10180 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10181 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10183 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10185 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10186 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10189 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10191 @cindex tables, in HTML
10192 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10194 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10195 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10196 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10197 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10200 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10202 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10203 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10206 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10207 @subsection Images in HTML export
10209 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10210 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10211 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10212 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10213 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10214 default@footnote{But see the variable
10215 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10216 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10217 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10218 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10219 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10220 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10221 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10222 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10225 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10228 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10229 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10230 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10233 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10235 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10236 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10241 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10243 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10244 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10248 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10249 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10250 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10251 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10252 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10253 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10254 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10255 found on the MathJax website, see
10256 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10257 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10258 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10259 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10262 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10265 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10266 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10269 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10270 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10271 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10272 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10273 You can still get this processing with
10276 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10279 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10280 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10282 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10283 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10284 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10285 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10286 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10287 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10288 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10289 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10290 respectively. For example
10293 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10294 (defun org-xor (a b)
10301 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10302 @subsection CSS support
10303 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10304 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10306 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10307 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10308 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10309 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10310 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10311 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10312 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10313 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10314 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10316 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10317 p.date @r{publishing date}
10318 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10319 .title @r{document title}
10320 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10321 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10322 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10323 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10324 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10325 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10326 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10327 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10328 .target @r{target for links}
10329 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10330 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10331 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10332 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10333 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10334 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10335 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10336 pre.example @r{normal example}
10337 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10338 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10339 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10340 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10341 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10344 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10345 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10346 @vindex org-export-html-style
10347 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10348 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10349 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10350 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10351 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10352 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10353 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10354 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10355 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10356 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10357 individually for each file, you can use
10361 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10365 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10366 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10367 referring to an external file.
10369 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10370 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10371 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10374 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10375 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10377 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10378 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10380 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10381 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10382 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10383 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10384 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10385 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10386 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10387 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10388 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10389 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10390 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10391 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10392 copy on your own web server.
10394 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10395 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10396 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10397 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10398 adding a single line to the Org file:
10400 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10402 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10406 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10407 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10411 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10412 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10413 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10414 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10415 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10416 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10417 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10418 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10419 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10420 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10421 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10422 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10423 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10424 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10425 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10426 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10427 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10428 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10429 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10430 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10431 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10432 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10433 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10434 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10435 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10438 @vindex org-infojs-options
10439 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10440 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10441 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10442 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10444 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10445 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10446 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10448 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10450 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10451 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10452 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10453 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10454 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10455 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10456 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10457 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10458 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10459 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10463 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10464 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10465 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10466 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10467 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10468 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10471 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10472 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10474 @cindex region, active
10475 @cindex active region
10476 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10478 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10479 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10480 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10481 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10482 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10483 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10484 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10485 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10486 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10487 property, that name will be used for the export.
10488 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10489 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10490 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10491 Export only the visible part of the document.
10492 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10493 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10494 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10496 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10497 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10499 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10500 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10501 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10502 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10505 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10506 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10507 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10508 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10509 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10510 convert them to a custom string depending on
10511 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10513 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10514 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10517 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10521 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10523 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10524 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10525 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10526 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10527 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10528 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10529 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10531 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10533 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10534 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10535 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10536 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10537 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10538 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10539 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10540 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10541 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10542 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10543 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10544 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10545 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10546 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10547 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10548 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10549 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10550 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10551 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10552 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10553 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10554 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10555 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10556 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10560 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10561 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10562 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10568 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10569 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10571 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10572 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10573 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10574 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10575 the following constructs:
10578 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10580 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10584 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10588 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10593 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10594 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10595 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10597 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10598 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10599 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10600 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10601 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10602 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10603 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10608 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10610 #+CAPTION: A long table
10612 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10617 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10621 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10623 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10625 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10630 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10631 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10632 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10633 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10635 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10636 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10637 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10638 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10639 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10640 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10641 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10642 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10643 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10644 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10645 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10646 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10647 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10648 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10649 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10650 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10652 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10653 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10654 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10655 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10656 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10657 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10661 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10663 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10664 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10665 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10666 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10668 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10672 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10673 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10674 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10676 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10677 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10679 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10680 @subsection Beamer class export
10682 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10683 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10684 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10686 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10687 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10688 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10689 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10690 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10691 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10692 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10693 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10694 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10695 structure of the presentation.
10697 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10698 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10699 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10700 editing special properties used by beamer.
10702 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10707 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10708 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10709 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10710 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10711 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10712 @item BEAMER_envargs
10713 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10714 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10715 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10716 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10717 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10720 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10721 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10722 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10723 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10724 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10725 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10726 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10727 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10729 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10730 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10734 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10735 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10736 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10737 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10738 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10739 in the presentation as well.
10741 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10742 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10743 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10744 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10745 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10746 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10747 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10749 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10757 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10758 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10759 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10762 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10763 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10764 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10765 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10767 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10770 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10771 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10772 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10773 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10774 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10775 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10776 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10778 * This is the first structural section
10780 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10781 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10784 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10787 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10788 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10792 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10794 for contributing to the discussion
10795 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10796 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10797 *** Request :B_block:
10798 Please test this stuff!
10804 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10806 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10807 @section DocBook export
10808 @cindex DocBook export
10810 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10812 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10813 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10814 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10815 tools and stylesheets.
10817 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10820 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10821 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10822 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10823 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10824 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10825 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10828 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10829 @subsection DocBook export commands
10831 @cindex region, active
10832 @cindex active region
10833 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10835 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10836 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10837 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10838 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10839 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10840 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10841 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10842 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10843 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10844 property, that name will be used for the export.
10845 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10846 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10848 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10849 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10850 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10851 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10852 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10853 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10855 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10856 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10857 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10858 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10859 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10860 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10862 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10863 Export only the visible part of the document.
10866 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10867 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10869 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10870 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10873 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10875 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10879 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10883 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10888 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10889 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10890 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10891 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10896 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10897 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10898 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10903 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10904 @subsection Recursive sections
10905 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10907 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10908 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e., @code{section} elements, are
10909 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10910 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10911 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10912 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10914 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10915 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10917 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10918 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10919 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10921 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10924 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10925 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10926 using the @code{table} element.
10928 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10929 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10930 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10931 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10933 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10934 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10935 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10936 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10937 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10938 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10939 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10940 @code{mediaobject} element.
10942 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10943 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10944 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10945 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10946 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10947 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10948 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10949 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10951 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10952 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10953 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10954 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10955 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10960 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10962 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10963 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10964 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10965 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10968 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10969 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10970 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10971 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10972 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10974 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10975 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10976 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10978 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10979 @vindex org-entities
10980 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10981 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10982 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10983 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10984 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10985 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10987 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10988 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10989 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10990 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10993 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10994 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10995 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10996 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11003 @c begin opendocument
11005 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11006 @section OpenDocument Text export
11007 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11009 @cindex OpenDocument
11010 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11011 @cindex LibreOffice
11013 @cindex org-modules
11015 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11016 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11017 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11018 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11019 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11020 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11023 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11024 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11025 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11026 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11027 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11028 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11029 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11030 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11031 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11032 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11033 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11036 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11037 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11039 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11040 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11042 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11043 @subsection ODT export commands
11045 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11046 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11048 @cindex region, active
11049 @cindex active region
11050 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11052 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11053 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11055 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11057 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11058 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11059 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11060 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11062 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11063 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11064 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11065 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11066 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11067 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11068 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11071 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11072 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11074 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11075 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11076 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11077 exporting to other formats}.
11080 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11081 @subsection Extending ODT export
11083 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11084 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11085 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11086 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11088 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11089 @cindex LibreOffice
11090 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11091 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11092 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11093 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11094 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11095 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11096 document converter}.
11098 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11099 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11101 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11102 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11103 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11104 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11105 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11106 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11107 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11108 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11110 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11111 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11113 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11114 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11115 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11116 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11117 the following command.
11119 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11122 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11123 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11124 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11127 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11128 @subsection Applying custom styles
11129 @cindex styles, custom
11130 @cindex template, custom
11132 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11133 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11134 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11135 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11136 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11137 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11138 users alike, and is described here.
11140 @subsubsection Applying custom styles: the easy way
11144 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11148 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11152 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11153 to locate the target styles---these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix---and
11154 modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11155 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11158 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11159 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11160 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11161 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11162 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11164 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11165 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11168 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11174 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11179 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11181 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11182 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11183 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11184 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11185 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11186 the factory settings.
11188 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11189 @subsection Links in ODT export
11190 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11192 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11193 Internet-style links for all other links.
11195 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11196 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11198 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11199 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11200 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11202 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11203 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11204 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11206 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11207 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables---tables
11208 that have column or row spans---is not supported. Such tables are
11209 stripped from the exported document.
11211 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11212 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11213 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11214 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11215 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11216 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11219 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11220 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11222 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11226 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11227 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11228 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11230 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11231 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11232 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11233 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11234 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11235 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11238 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11239 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11240 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11241 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11242 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11244 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11245 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11246 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11248 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11249 @subsection Images in ODT export
11250 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11251 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11253 @subsubheading Embedding images
11254 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11255 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11256 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11266 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11267 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11268 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11269 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11270 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11273 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11276 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11279 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11280 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11282 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11283 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11284 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11285 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11286 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11287 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11288 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11289 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11290 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11291 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11292 converted in to units of centimeters using
11293 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11294 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11295 achieve the best results.
11297 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11300 @item Explicitly size the image
11301 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11304 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11308 @item Scale the image
11309 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11312 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11316 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11317 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11318 height:width ratio, do the following:
11321 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11325 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11326 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11327 height:width ratio, do the following
11330 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11335 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11338 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11339 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11340 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property:
11341 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11343 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11345 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11349 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11350 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11352 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11355 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11356 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11359 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11360 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11362 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11363 document in one of the following ways:
11369 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11375 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11376 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11377 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11378 the exported document.
11380 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11381 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11383 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11384 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11385 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11387 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11388 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11389 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11392 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11393 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11394 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11395 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11398 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11399 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11403 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11404 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11406 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11407 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11408 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11414 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11417 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11420 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11421 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11422 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11425 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11426 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11428 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11429 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11430 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11431 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11443 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11444 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11446 You can label and caption various category of objects---an inline image, a
11447 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula---using @code{#+LABEL} and
11448 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11449 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11450 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11451 appearance in the Org file.
11453 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11454 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11458 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11459 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11463 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11466 Figure 2: Bell curve
11469 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11470 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11471 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11472 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11473 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11476 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11477 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11480 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11484 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11487 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11488 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11490 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11491 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11492 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11493 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11494 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11495 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11496 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11498 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11499 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11500 by customizing the variable
11501 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11503 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11504 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11505 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11507 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11508 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11510 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11511 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11512 that would be of interest to power users.
11515 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11516 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11517 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11518 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11519 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11522 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11523 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11525 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11528 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11529 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11530 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11531 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11534 @item Register the converter
11536 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11537 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11538 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11539 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11541 @item Configure its capabilities
11543 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11544 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11545 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11546 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11547 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11548 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11549 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11550 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11552 @item Choose the converter
11554 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11555 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11556 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11559 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11560 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11561 @cindex styles, custom
11562 @cindex template, custom
11564 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11565 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11566 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11569 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11570 @subsubheading Factory styles
11572 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11573 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11574 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11577 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11579 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11581 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11582 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11586 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11589 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11593 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11595 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11597 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11598 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11599 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11601 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11602 file serves the following purposes:
11606 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11610 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11611 elements that control how various entities---tables, images, equations,
11612 etc.---are numbered.
11616 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11617 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11618 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11619 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11620 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11624 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11626 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11628 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11629 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11632 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11634 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11636 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11638 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11641 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11643 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11644 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11645 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11647 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11648 like header and footer images.
11652 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11655 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11657 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11659 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11660 in the final output.
11663 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11664 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11666 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11667 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11668 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11671 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11673 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11674 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11677 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11678 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11682 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11683 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11684 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11687 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11688 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11692 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11694 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11695 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11698 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11701 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11702 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11703 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11706 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11707 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11708 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11712 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11714 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11715 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11717 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11722 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11723 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11730 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11731 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11732 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11735 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11736 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11737 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11739 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11741 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11742 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11746 @subsubheading Custom table styles: an illustration
11748 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11749 the table that follows.
11752 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11753 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11754 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11755 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11756 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11757 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11758 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11759 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11763 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11764 | Name | Phone | Age |
11765 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11766 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11769 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11770 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11771 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11772 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11773 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11774 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11775 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11776 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11778 @subsubheading Custom table styles: the nitty-gritty
11779 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11783 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11784 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11786 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11787 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11801 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11802 template using a well-defined convention.
11804 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11805 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11806 the following table.
11808 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11809 @headitem Table cell type
11810 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11811 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11816 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11817 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11819 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11820 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11822 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11823 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11825 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11826 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11828 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11829 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11831 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11832 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11834 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11835 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11837 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11838 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11840 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11841 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11844 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11846 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11847 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11851 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11852 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11853 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11854 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11855 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11856 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11858 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11859 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11860 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11863 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11864 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11867 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11868 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11869 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11870 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11873 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11874 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11875 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11876 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11877 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11878 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11879 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11880 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11884 Associate a table with the table style
11886 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11887 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11890 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11891 | Name | Phone | Age |
11892 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11893 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11897 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11898 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11900 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11901 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11902 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11903 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11904 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11906 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11907 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11908 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11909 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11911 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11912 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11913 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11914 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11915 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11916 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11918 @c end opendocument
11920 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11921 @section TaskJuggler export
11922 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11923 @cindex Project management
11925 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11926 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11927 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11930 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11931 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11932 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11935 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11936 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11937 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11940 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11943 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11944 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11946 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11947 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11952 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11953 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11954 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11955 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11956 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11957 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11958 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11959 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11960 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11961 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11963 @subsection Resources
11965 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11966 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11967 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11968 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11969 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11970 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11971 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11972 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11973 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11974 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11975 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11976 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11977 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11979 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11980 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11983 @subsection Export of properties
11985 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e., if a
11986 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
11987 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
11988 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
11989 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
11990 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
11991 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
11992 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
11993 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
11995 @subsection Dependencies
11997 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
11998 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
11999 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12000 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12001 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12002 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12003 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12004 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12005 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12006 examples should illustrate this:
12011 :task_id: preparation
12014 * Training material
12016 :task_id: training_material
12019 ** Markup Guidelines
12023 ** Workflow Guidelines
12030 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12034 @subsection Reports
12036 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12037 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g., gantt chart, resource
12038 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12039 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
12040 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
12041 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
12042 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
12043 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
12045 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12046 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12048 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12049 @section Freemind export
12050 @cindex Freemind export
12053 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12056 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12057 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12058 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12061 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12062 @section XOXO export
12063 @cindex XOXO export
12065 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12066 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12067 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12070 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12071 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12072 @file{myfile.html}.
12073 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12074 Export only the visible part of the document.
12077 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12078 @section iCalendar export
12079 @cindex iCalendar export
12081 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12082 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12083 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12084 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12085 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12086 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12087 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12088 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12089 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12090 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12091 included in the export, configure the variable
12092 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12093 and TODO items as VTODO@. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12094 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12095 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12096 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12097 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12098 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12099 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12100 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12103 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12104 @cindex property, ID
12105 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12106 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12107 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12108 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12109 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12110 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12111 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12112 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12113 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12116 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12117 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12118 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12119 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12120 @vindex org-agenda-files
12121 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12122 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12123 file will be written.
12124 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12125 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12126 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12127 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12128 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12131 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12132 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12133 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12134 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12135 @cindex property, LOCATION
12136 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12137 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12138 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12139 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12140 and the description from the body (limited to
12141 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12143 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12144 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12146 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12147 @chapter Publishing
12150 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12151 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12152 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12153 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12156 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12157 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12159 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12162 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12163 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12164 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12165 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12168 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12169 @section Configuration
12171 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12172 and many other properties of a project.
12175 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12176 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12177 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12178 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12179 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12180 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12181 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12182 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12185 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12186 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12187 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12188 @cindex projects, for publishing
12190 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12191 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12192 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12193 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12196 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12197 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12199 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12203 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12204 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12205 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12206 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12207 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12208 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12209 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12212 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12213 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12214 @cindex directories, for publishing
12216 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12217 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12218 and where to put published files.
12220 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12221 @item @code{:base-directory}
12222 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12223 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12224 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12225 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12226 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12227 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12228 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12229 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12230 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12231 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12232 variable @code{project-plist}.
12233 @item @code{:completion-function}
12234 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12235 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12236 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12237 @code{project-plist}.
12241 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12242 @subsection Selecting files
12243 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12245 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12246 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12248 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12249 @item @code{:base-extension}
12250 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12251 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12252 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12254 @item @code{:exclude}
12255 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12256 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12259 @item @code{:include}
12260 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12261 and @code{:exclude}.
12263 @item @code{:recursive}
12264 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12267 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12268 @subsection Publishing action
12269 @cindex action, for publishing
12271 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12272 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12273 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12274 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12275 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12276 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12277 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12278 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12279 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12280 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12281 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12282 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12283 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12284 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12285 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12286 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12287 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12288 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12289 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12291 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12292 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12293 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12294 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12295 @item @code{:plain-source}
12296 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12297 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12298 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12301 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12302 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12303 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12304 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12305 and place the result into the destination folder.
12307 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12308 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12309 @cindex options, for publishing
12311 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12312 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12313 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12314 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12315 respective variable for details.
12317 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12318 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12319 @vindex org-export-default-language
12320 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12321 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12322 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12323 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12324 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12325 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12326 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12327 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12328 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12329 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12330 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12331 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12332 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12333 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12334 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12335 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12336 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12337 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12338 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12339 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12340 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12341 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12342 @vindex org-export-author-info
12343 @vindex org-export-email-info
12344 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12345 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12346 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12347 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12348 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12349 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12350 @vindex org-export-html-style
12351 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12352 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12353 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12354 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12355 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12356 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12357 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12358 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12359 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12360 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12361 @vindex user-full-name
12362 @vindex user-mail-address
12363 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12364 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12366 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12367 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12368 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12369 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12370 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12371 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12372 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12373 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12374 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12375 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12376 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12377 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12378 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12379 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12380 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12381 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12382 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12383 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12384 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12385 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12386 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12387 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12388 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12389 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12390 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12391 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12392 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12393 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12394 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12395 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12396 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12397 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12398 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12399 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12400 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12401 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12402 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12403 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12404 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12405 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12406 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12407 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12408 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12409 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12410 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12411 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12412 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12413 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12414 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12415 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12418 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12419 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12420 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12421 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12426 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12427 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12428 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12429 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12430 options}), however, override everything.
12432 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12433 @subsection Links between published files
12434 @cindex links, publishing
12436 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12437 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12438 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12439 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12440 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12441 you publish them to HTML@. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12442 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12443 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12446 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12447 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12448 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12449 an example of this usage.
12451 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12452 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12453 location. In this case, use the property
12455 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12456 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12457 @tab Function to validate links
12461 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12462 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12463 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12464 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12465 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12466 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12467 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12469 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12470 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12471 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12473 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12474 a map of files for a given project.
12476 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12477 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12478 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12479 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12481 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12482 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12483 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12485 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12486 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12488 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12489 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12490 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12491 of links to all files in the project.
12493 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12494 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12495 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12496 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12498 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12499 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12500 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12501 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12502 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12503 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12504 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12506 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12507 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12509 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12510 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12511 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12512 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12513 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12514 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12515 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12517 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12518 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12519 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12520 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12522 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12523 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12524 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12525 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12529 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12530 @subsection Generating an index
12531 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12533 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12535 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12536 @item @code{:makeindex}
12537 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12538 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12541 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12542 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12543 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12544 a title, style information, etc.
12546 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12547 @section Uploading files
12551 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12552 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12553 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12554 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12555 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12558 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12559 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12560 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12561 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12562 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12564 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12565 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12566 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12567 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12568 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12569 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12572 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12573 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12574 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12575 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12576 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12577 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12579 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12580 @section Sample configuration
12582 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12583 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12584 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12587 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12588 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12591 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12592 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12594 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12595 directory on the local machine.
12598 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12600 :base-directory "~/org/"
12601 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12602 :section-numbers nil
12603 :table-of-contents nil
12604 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12605 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12606 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12609 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12610 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12612 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12613 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12614 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12617 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12618 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12619 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12620 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12623 file:../images/myimage.png
12626 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12627 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12628 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12631 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12633 :base-directory "~/org/"
12634 :base-extension "org"
12635 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12636 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12637 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12639 :section-numbers nil
12640 :table-of-contents nil
12641 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12642 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12646 :base-directory "~/images/"
12647 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12648 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12649 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12652 :base-directory "~/other/"
12653 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12654 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12655 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12656 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12659 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12660 @section Triggering publication
12662 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12665 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12666 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12667 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12668 Publish the project containing the current file.
12669 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12670 Publish only the current file.
12671 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12672 Publish every project.
12675 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12676 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12677 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12678 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12679 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12680 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12681 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12683 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12684 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12686 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12687 @chapter Working with source code
12688 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12689 @cindex Davison, Dan
12690 @cindex source code, working with
12692 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12696 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12697 (defun org-xor (a b)
12703 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12704 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12705 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12706 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12707 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12708 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12710 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12713 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12714 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12715 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12716 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12717 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12718 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12719 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12720 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12721 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12722 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12723 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12724 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12727 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12728 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12730 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12731 @section Structure of code blocks
12732 @cindex code block, structure
12733 @cindex source code, block structure
12735 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12737 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12738 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12739 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12743 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12748 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12749 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12750 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12751 @cindex source code, inline
12753 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12756 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12762 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12766 @item <#+NAME: name>
12767 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12768 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12769 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12770 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12771 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12772 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12776 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12777 @cindex source code, language
12779 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12780 @ref{Literal examples})
12781 @cindex source code, switches
12782 @item <header arguments>
12783 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12784 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12785 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12786 basis using properties.
12787 @item source code, header arguments
12789 Source code in the specified language.
12792 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12793 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12795 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12796 @section Editing source code
12797 @cindex code block, editing
12798 @cindex source code, editing
12801 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12802 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12803 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12804 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12806 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12807 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12808 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12809 further configuration options.
12812 @item org-src-lang-modes
12813 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12814 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12815 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12816 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12817 @item org-src-window-setup
12818 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12819 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12820 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12821 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12822 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12823 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12824 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12827 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12828 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12830 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12831 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12833 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12834 @section Exporting code blocks
12835 @cindex code block, exporting
12836 @cindex source code, exporting
12838 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12839 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12840 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12841 However, for some languages (e.g., @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12842 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12843 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12845 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12848 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12850 @item :exports code
12851 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12852 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12853 @item :exports results
12854 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12855 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12856 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12857 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12858 block will not be exported.
12859 @item :exports both
12860 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12861 @item :exports none
12862 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12865 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12866 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12867 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12868 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12869 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12870 markup language for a wiki.
12872 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12873 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12874 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12875 @section Extracting source code
12877 @cindex source code, extracting
12878 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12880 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12881 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12882 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12883 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12884 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12886 @subsubheading Header arguments
12889 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12891 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12892 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12893 for the block language.
12894 @item :tangle filename
12895 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12899 @subsubheading Functions
12901 @item org-babel-tangle
12902 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12903 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12904 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12907 @subsubheading Hooks
12909 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12910 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12911 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12912 of tangled code files.
12915 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12916 @section Evaluating code blocks
12917 @cindex code block, evaluating
12918 @cindex source code, evaluating
12921 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12922 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12923 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12924 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12925 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12926 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12927 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12928 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12929 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12930 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12932 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12933 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12934 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12935 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12936 used to define a code block).
12939 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12940 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12941 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12942 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12943 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12944 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12947 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12948 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12949 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12950 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12951 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12953 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12956 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12957 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12960 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12963 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12964 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12969 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12971 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12972 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12973 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12974 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12975 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12976 @item <inside header arguments>
12977 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12978 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12979 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12980 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12981 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12982 @item <end header arguments>
12983 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12984 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12985 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
12986 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
12987 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
12989 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
12990 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
12993 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
12994 @section Library of Babel
12995 @cindex babel, library of
12996 @cindex source code, library
12997 @cindex code block, library
12999 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13000 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13001 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13002 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13005 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13006 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13008 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13009 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13010 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13014 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13015 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13018 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13020 @cindex babel, languages
13021 @cindex source code, languages
13022 @cindex code block, languages
13024 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13026 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13027 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13028 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13029 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13030 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13031 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13032 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13033 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13034 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13035 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13036 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13037 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13038 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13039 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13040 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13041 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13042 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13043 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13044 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13045 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13048 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13049 available, it can be found at
13050 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13052 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13053 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13054 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13055 to your emacs configuration.
13058 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13059 @code{R} code blocks.
13063 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13064 'org-babel-load-languages
13065 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13069 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13070 elisp file with @code{require}.
13073 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13077 (require 'ob-clojure)
13080 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13081 @section Header arguments
13082 @cindex code block, header arguments
13083 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13085 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13086 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13087 describes each header argument in detail.
13090 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13091 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13094 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13095 @subsection Using header arguments
13097 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13098 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13100 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13101 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13102 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13103 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13104 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13105 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13109 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13110 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13111 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13112 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13113 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13117 :results => "replace"
13124 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13126 @c ((:session . "none")
13127 @c (:results . "replace")
13128 @c (:exports . "code")
13130 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13134 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13137 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13138 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13139 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13143 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13144 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13145 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13148 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13149 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13150 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13151 language-specific documentation available online at
13152 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13154 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13155 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13156 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13157 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13158 @ref{Property syntax}).
13160 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13161 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13162 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13163 inserted into the buffer.
13166 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13167 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13170 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13171 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13173 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13174 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13175 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13178 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13181 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13182 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13183 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13184 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13185 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13186 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13196 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13197 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13198 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13199 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13200 in Org mode documents.
13202 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13203 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13205 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13206 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13207 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13208 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13209 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13210 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13211 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13212 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13213 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13214 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13218 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13220 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13223 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13226 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13229 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13230 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13231 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13235 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13238 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13239 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13240 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13247 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13250 #+NAME: named-block
13251 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13252 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13253 (message "data:%S" data)
13256 #+RESULTS: named-block
13260 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13261 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13262 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13264 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13265 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13266 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13269 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13270 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13273 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13276 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13277 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13280 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13283 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13284 @subsection Specific header arguments
13285 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13286 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13289 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13290 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13291 be collected and handled
13292 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13293 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13294 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13295 directory for code block execution
13296 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13297 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13298 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13299 files during tangling
13300 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13302 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13304 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13305 expansion during tangling
13306 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13307 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13308 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13309 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13310 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13311 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13312 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13313 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13314 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13315 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13316 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13317 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13320 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13323 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13324 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13325 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13326 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13327 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13328 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13329 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13331 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13332 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13333 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13334 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13335 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13338 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13339 Indexable variable values}).
13341 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13342 @code{:var} header argument.
13348 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13349 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13350 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13351 results of evaluating another code block.
13353 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13358 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13361 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13367 #+NAME: table-length
13368 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13372 #+RESULTS: table-length
13377 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13378 carried through to the source code block)
13381 #+NAME: example-list
13387 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13395 @item code block without arguments
13396 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13397 optionally followed by parentheses
13400 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13408 @item code block with arguments
13409 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13410 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13411 code block name using standard function call syntax
13415 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13423 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13431 @item literal example
13432 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13435 #+NAME: literal-example
13441 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13442 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13443 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13446 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13447 : A literal example
13448 : on two lines for you.
13454 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13455 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13456 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13457 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13458 following the source name.
13461 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13462 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13467 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13468 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13469 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13470 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13471 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13472 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13473 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13474 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13475 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13478 #+NAME: example-table
13484 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13492 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13493 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13494 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13498 #+NAME: example-table
13505 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13515 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13516 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13517 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13518 column is referenced.
13521 #+NAME: example-table
13527 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13535 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13536 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13537 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13541 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13542 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13543 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13544 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13547 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13555 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13557 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13558 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13559 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13560 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13561 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13562 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13563 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13564 evaluation of the code block body.
13567 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13572 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13573 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13579 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13588 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13589 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13591 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13592 per class may be supplied per code block.
13596 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13597 from the code block
13599 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13600 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13603 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13604 block should be handled.
13607 @subsubheading Collection
13608 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13609 should be collected from the code block.
13613 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13614 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13615 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13616 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13617 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13618 @item @code{output}
13619 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13620 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13621 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13624 @subsubheading Type
13626 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13627 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13628 table or scalar depending on their value.
13631 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13632 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13633 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13634 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13636 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13637 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13638 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13639 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13640 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13641 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13643 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13644 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13646 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13647 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13648 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13650 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
13651 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
13652 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
13654 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13655 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13657 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13658 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13660 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13661 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13663 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13664 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13665 @code{:results value pp}.
13666 @item @code{drawer}
13667 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13668 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13669 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13672 @subsubheading Handling
13673 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13674 results once they are collected.
13677 @item @code{silent}
13678 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13679 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13680 @item @code{replace}
13681 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13682 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13683 @code{:results output replace}.
13684 @item @code{append}
13685 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13686 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13687 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13688 @item @code{prepend}
13689 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13690 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13691 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13694 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13695 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13697 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13698 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13699 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13700 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13701 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13702 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13703 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13704 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13706 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13707 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13708 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13710 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13711 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13713 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13714 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13715 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13716 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13717 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13719 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13720 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13722 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13723 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13724 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13725 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13726 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13727 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13728 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13730 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13731 (e.g., @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13732 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13734 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13735 in your home directory, you could use
13738 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13739 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13743 @subsubheading Remote execution
13744 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13745 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13748 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13749 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13753 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13754 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13755 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13758 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13759 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13762 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13765 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13766 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13767 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13768 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13770 @subsubheading Further points
13774 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13775 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13776 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13778 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13779 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13780 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13781 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13782 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13783 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13784 which the link does not point.
13787 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13788 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13790 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13791 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13795 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13796 @code{:exports code}.
13797 @item @code{results}
13798 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13799 @code{:exports results}.
13801 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13802 @code{:exports both}.
13804 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13807 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13808 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13810 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13811 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13814 @item @code{tangle}
13815 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13816 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13817 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13819 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13820 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13822 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13823 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13824 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13827 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13828 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13830 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13831 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13832 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13834 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13835 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13836 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13837 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13838 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13839 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13843 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13845 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13846 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13848 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13850 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13852 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13853 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13855 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13857 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13858 references in the code block body in link comments.
13861 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13862 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13863 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13864 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13865 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13870 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13872 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13875 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13876 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13878 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13879 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13880 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13881 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13882 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13884 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13885 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13887 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13888 language where state is preserved.
13890 By default, a session is not started.
13892 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13893 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13894 interpreted language.
13896 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13897 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13899 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13900 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13901 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13902 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13903 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13907 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13908 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13910 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13911 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13912 @item @code{tangle}
13913 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13914 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13915 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13916 @item @code{no-export}
13917 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13918 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13919 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13920 @item @code{strip-export}
13921 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13922 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13923 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13925 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13926 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13929 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13930 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13931 @code{<<reference>>}.
13932 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13933 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13934 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13946 -- multi-line body of example
13949 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13950 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13953 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13954 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13955 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13956 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13957 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13958 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13960 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13961 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13962 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13963 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13964 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13968 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13971 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13973 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13976 ** query all mounted disks
13981 ** strip the header row
13986 ** sort by the percent full
13988 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
13991 ** extract the mount point
13993 |awk '@{print $2@}'
13997 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
13998 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14001 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14002 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14004 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14005 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14008 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14009 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14011 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14012 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14013 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14014 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14015 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14016 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14017 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14021 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14022 every time it is called.
14024 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14025 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14026 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14027 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14028 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14031 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14032 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14033 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14034 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14035 changed since it was last run.
14039 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14043 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14047 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14051 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14055 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14056 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14058 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14059 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14060 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14061 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14062 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14065 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14068 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14069 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14071 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14072 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14073 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14077 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14078 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14079 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14080 default value yields the following results.
14083 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14091 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14095 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14102 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14105 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14113 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14117 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14126 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14127 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14129 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14130 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14131 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14132 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14133 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14134 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14138 If an input table looks like it has column names
14139 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14140 names will be removed from the table before
14141 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14144 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14150 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14151 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14152 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14155 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14162 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14163 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14166 No column name pre-processing takes place
14169 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14170 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e., the second row is not an
14174 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14175 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14177 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14178 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14182 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14185 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14186 and is then reapplied to the results.
14189 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14190 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14191 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14193 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14194 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14195 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14198 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14199 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14200 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14203 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14204 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14208 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14209 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14211 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14212 (e.g., @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14213 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14214 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14216 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14217 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14218 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14219 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14220 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14221 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14222 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14223 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14227 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14229 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14230 @item never-export or no-export
14231 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14234 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14237 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14238 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14241 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14242 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14243 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14244 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14245 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14246 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14247 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14249 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14250 @section Results of evaluation
14251 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14252 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14254 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14255 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14256 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14257 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14259 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14260 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14261 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14262 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14265 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14266 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14267 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14269 @subsection Non-session
14270 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14271 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14272 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14273 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14274 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14275 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14276 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14278 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14279 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14281 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14282 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14283 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14284 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14287 @subsection Session
14288 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14289 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14290 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14291 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14292 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14293 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14294 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14295 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14297 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14298 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14299 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14300 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14303 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14304 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14305 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14306 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14307 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14308 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14309 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14312 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14323 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14326 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14338 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14339 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14342 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14343 @section Noweb reference syntax
14344 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14345 @cindex syntax, noweb
14346 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14348 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14349 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14350 familiar Noweb syntax:
14353 <<code-block-name>>
14356 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14357 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14358 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14359 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14360 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14361 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14363 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14364 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14365 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14368 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14371 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14372 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14373 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14374 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14377 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14378 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14379 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14380 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14383 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14384 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14385 @cindex code block, key bindings
14387 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14390 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14393 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14395 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14397 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14399 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14401 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14404 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14406 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14408 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14409 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14411 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14412 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14414 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14415 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14417 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14418 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14420 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14421 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14423 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14424 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14426 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14427 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14429 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14430 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14432 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14433 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14435 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14436 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14438 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14439 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14441 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14442 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14444 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14445 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14447 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14448 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14450 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14451 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14453 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14454 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14456 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14457 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14459 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14460 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14462 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14463 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14465 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14466 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14468 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14469 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14471 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14472 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14475 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14476 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14478 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14479 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14480 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14481 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14482 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14483 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14484 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14485 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14486 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14489 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14490 @section Batch execution
14491 @cindex code block, batch execution
14492 @cindex source code, batch execution
14494 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14495 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14497 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14501 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14503 # tangle files with org-mode
14508 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14510 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14515 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14516 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
14517 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14518 (mapc (lambda (file)
14519 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14521 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14524 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14525 @chapter Miscellaneous
14528 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14529 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14530 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14531 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14532 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14533 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14534 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14535 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14536 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14537 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14538 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14542 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14543 @section Completion
14544 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14545 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14546 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14547 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14548 @cindex completion, of tags
14549 @cindex completion, of property keys
14550 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14551 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14552 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14553 @cindex dictionary word completion
14554 @cindex option keyword completion
14555 @cindex tag completion
14556 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14558 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14559 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14560 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14561 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14562 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14564 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14565 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14566 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14569 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14571 Complete word at point
14574 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14576 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14578 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14579 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14581 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14582 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14583 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14584 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14586 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14587 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14590 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14592 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14593 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14594 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14595 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14597 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14598 i.e., valid keys for this line.
14600 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14604 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14605 @section Easy Templates
14606 @cindex template insertion
14607 @cindex insertion, of templates
14609 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14610 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14611 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14612 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14613 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14615 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14616 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14617 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14619 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14621 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14622 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14623 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14624 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14625 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14626 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14627 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14628 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14629 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14630 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14631 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14632 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14633 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14634 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14637 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14638 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14640 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14641 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14642 additional details.
14644 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14645 @section Speed keys
14647 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14648 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14650 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14651 beginning of a headline, i.e., before the first star. Configure the variable
14652 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14653 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14654 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14655 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14656 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14657 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14659 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14660 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14662 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14663 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14665 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14667 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14668 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14669 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14670 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14671 these precautions intact.
14673 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14674 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14675 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14677 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14680 @item Source code blocks
14681 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14682 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14683 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14684 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14685 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14687 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14688 which take off the default security brakes.
14690 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14691 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14692 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14693 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14694 ask and nil not to ask.
14697 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14701 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14702 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14703 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14706 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14707 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14708 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14711 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14712 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14714 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14715 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14718 @item Formulas in tables
14719 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14720 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14723 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14724 @section Customization
14725 @cindex customization
14726 @cindex options, for customization
14727 @cindex variables, for customization
14729 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14730 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14731 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14732 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14733 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14734 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14735 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14737 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14738 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14739 @cindex in-buffer settings
14740 @cindex special keywords
14742 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14743 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14744 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14745 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14746 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14747 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14748 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14749 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14750 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14752 @vindex org-archive-location
14754 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14755 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14756 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14757 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14758 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14760 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14761 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14762 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14763 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14764 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14765 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14766 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14768 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14769 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14770 @vindex org-table-formula
14771 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14772 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14773 The global version of this variable is
14774 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14775 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14776 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14778 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14779 @vindex org-drawers
14780 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14781 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14782 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14783 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14784 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14785 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14786 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14787 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14788 @vindex org-highest-priority
14789 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14790 @vindex org-default-priority
14791 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14792 must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The highest priority must
14793 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14794 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14795 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14796 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14797 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14798 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14799 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14800 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14801 (i.e., when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14802 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14803 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14804 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14805 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14808 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14809 Org file is being visited.
14811 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14812 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14813 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14815 @vindex org-startup-folded
14816 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14817 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14818 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14819 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14821 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14822 content @r{all headlines}
14823 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14824 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14827 @vindex org-startup-indented
14828 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14829 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14830 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14831 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14833 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14834 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14837 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14838 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14839 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14840 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14842 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14843 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14845 align @r{align all tables}
14846 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14849 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14850 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14851 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14852 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14853 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14854 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14856 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14857 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14860 @vindex org-log-done
14861 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14862 @vindex org-log-repeat
14863 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14864 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14865 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14866 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14867 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14868 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14869 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14870 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14871 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14872 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14873 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14874 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14875 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14876 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14877 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14878 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14879 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14880 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14881 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14882 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14884 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14885 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14886 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14887 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14888 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14889 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14890 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14891 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14892 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14893 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14894 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14895 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14896 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14897 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14898 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14899 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14900 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14902 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14903 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14904 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14905 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14906 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14907 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14908 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14909 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14910 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14911 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14913 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14914 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14915 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14916 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14917 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14918 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14920 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14921 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14922 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14923 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14924 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14925 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14927 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14929 @vindex constants-unit-system
14930 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14931 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14932 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14933 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14935 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14936 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14938 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14939 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14940 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14941 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14942 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14943 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14944 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14945 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14946 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14947 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14948 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14949 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14950 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14951 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14952 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14954 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14955 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14956 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14957 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14958 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14959 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14960 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14961 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14962 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14964 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14965 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14966 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14967 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14968 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14970 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14971 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14973 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14974 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14975 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14976 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14977 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14979 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14980 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14982 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14983 @vindex org-tag-alist
14984 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14985 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14986 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
14988 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
14989 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
14990 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
14991 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
14992 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
14993 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
14994 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
14995 @ref{Export options}.
14996 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
14997 @vindex org-todo-keywords
14998 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
14999 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15002 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15003 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15005 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15007 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15008 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15009 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15010 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15011 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15012 what this means in different contexts.
15016 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15017 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15019 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15020 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15023 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15024 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15026 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15029 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15030 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15033 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15034 corresponding links in this buffer.
15036 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15037 drawer, offer property commands.
15039 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15040 definition, and vice versa.
15042 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15044 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15047 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15050 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15053 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15056 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15057 @section A cleaner outline view
15058 @cindex hiding leading stars
15059 @cindex dynamic indentation
15060 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15061 @cindex clean outline view
15063 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15064 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15065 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15066 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15067 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15071 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15072 ** Second level | * Second level
15073 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15074 some text | some text
15075 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15076 more text | more text
15077 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15083 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15084 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15085 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15086 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15087 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15088 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15089 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15090 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15091 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15092 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15093 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15094 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15095 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15096 @code{nil}.}; see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15097 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15098 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15099 individual files using
15105 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15106 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15107 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15112 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15113 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15114 with the headline, like
15118 more text, now indented
15121 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15122 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15123 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15124 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15127 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15128 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15129 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15130 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15134 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15135 #+STARTUP: showstars
15138 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15142 * Top level headline
15150 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15151 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15152 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15153 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15154 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15155 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15156 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15159 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15160 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15161 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15162 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15163 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc.}. In this
15164 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15165 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15166 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15167 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15174 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15175 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15176 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15177 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15180 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15181 @section Using Org on a tty
15182 @cindex tty key bindings
15184 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15185 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15186 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15187 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15188 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15189 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15190 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15191 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15192 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15193 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15194 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15196 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15197 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15198 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15199 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15200 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15201 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15202 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15203 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15204 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15205 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15206 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15207 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15208 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15209 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15210 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15211 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15212 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15213 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15214 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15215 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15219 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15220 @section Interaction with other packages
15221 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15222 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15223 with other code out there.
15226 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15227 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15230 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15231 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15234 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15235 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15236 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15237 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15238 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15239 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15240 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15241 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15242 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15243 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15244 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15245 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15246 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15247 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15248 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15249 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15250 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15251 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15252 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15253 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15254 @samp{Mega}, etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15255 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15256 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15257 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15258 @file{constants.el}.
15259 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15260 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15261 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15262 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15263 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15264 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15265 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15266 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15267 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15269 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15270 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15272 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15273 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15274 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15275 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15276 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15277 @cindex Wiegley, John
15278 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15279 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15280 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15281 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15282 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15283 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15284 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15285 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15286 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15287 @cindex @file{table.el}
15288 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15290 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15291 @cindex @file{table.el}
15292 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15294 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15295 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15296 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15297 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15298 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15299 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15300 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15303 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15304 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15306 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15307 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15308 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15309 format. See the documentation string of the command
15310 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15313 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15314 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15315 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15316 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15317 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15318 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15319 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15322 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15323 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15327 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15328 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15329 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15330 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15331 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15332 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15333 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15334 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15335 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15336 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15337 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15338 cursor moves across a special context.
15340 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15341 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15342 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15343 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15344 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15345 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15346 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15347 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15348 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15349 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15350 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15351 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15352 buffer (but not during date selection).
15355 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15356 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15357 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15360 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15361 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15362 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15363 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15365 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
15366 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
15368 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
15369 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
15370 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
15374 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
15377 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15378 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15379 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15380 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15381 fixed this problem:
15384 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15386 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15387 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15390 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15391 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15395 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15396 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15399 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15402 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15404 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15405 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15406 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15407 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15410 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15411 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15412 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15413 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15414 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15415 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15419 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15420 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15421 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15422 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15423 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15426 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15427 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15429 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15430 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15431 another key for this command, or override the key in
15432 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15435 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15440 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15441 @section org-crypt.el
15442 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15443 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15445 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15446 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15449 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15450 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15451 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15453 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15457 (require 'org-crypt)
15458 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15459 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15461 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15462 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15463 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15465 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15466 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15467 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15468 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15471 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15473 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15476 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15477 being encrypted again.
15479 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15483 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15487 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15488 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15489 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15490 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15491 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15492 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15493 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15494 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15495 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15496 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15499 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15503 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15504 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15505 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15506 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15507 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15509 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15510 @section Add-on packages
15511 @cindex add-on packages
15513 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15514 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15515 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15516 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15517 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15518 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15522 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15523 @section Adding hyperlink types
15524 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15526 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15527 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15528 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15529 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15530 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15534 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15538 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15539 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15541 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15542 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15544 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15546 (defun org-man-open (path)
15547 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15548 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15549 (funcall org-man-command path))
15551 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15552 "Store a link to a manpage."
15553 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15554 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15555 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15556 (link (concat "man:" page))
15557 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15558 (org-store-link-props
15561 :description description))))
15563 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15564 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15565 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15566 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15567 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15568 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15572 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15576 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15583 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15586 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15589 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15590 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15591 that will be called to follow such a link.
15593 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15594 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15595 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15596 buffer displaying a man page.
15599 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15600 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15601 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15602 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15603 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15604 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15605 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15607 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15608 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15609 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15610 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15611 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15612 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15613 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15614 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15615 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15616 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15617 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15618 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15620 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15621 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
15622 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15623 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15625 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15626 @section Context-sensitive commands
15627 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15628 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15629 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15631 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15632 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15633 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15635 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15636 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15637 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15638 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15639 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15640 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15641 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15645 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15646 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15647 (if (save-excursion
15648 (beginning-of-line 1)
15649 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15650 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15651 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15652 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15654 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15657 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15658 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15659 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15660 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15661 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15664 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15665 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15666 @cindex tables, in other modes
15667 @cindex lists, in other modes
15668 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15670 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15671 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15672 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15673 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15674 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15677 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15678 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15679 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15680 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15681 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15682 for a very flexible system.
15684 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15685 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15686 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15687 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15691 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15692 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15693 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15694 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15697 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15698 @subsection Radio tables
15699 @cindex radio tables
15701 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15702 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15703 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15704 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15707 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15708 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15712 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15713 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15717 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15721 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15722 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15723 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15724 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15725 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15726 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15727 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15731 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15734 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15735 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15736 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15737 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15738 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15739 additional columns.
15742 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15743 the table. The default value is nil.
15747 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15748 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15749 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15750 number of different solutions:
15754 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15755 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15756 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15758 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15759 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15762 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15763 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15764 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15765 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15769 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15770 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15771 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15773 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15774 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15775 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15776 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15777 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15778 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15779 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15780 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15781 will then get the following template:
15783 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15785 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15786 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15788 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15794 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15795 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15796 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15797 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15798 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15799 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15800 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15801 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15802 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15803 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15804 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15805 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15808 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15809 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15811 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15812 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15813 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15814 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15815 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15816 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15817 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15818 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15823 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15824 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15826 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15827 want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make sure
15828 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15829 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e., to not produce
15830 header and footer commands of the target table:
15833 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15834 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15835 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15836 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15840 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15841 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15842 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15843 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15844 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15845 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15846 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15850 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15851 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15852 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15853 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15856 @item :splice nil/t
15857 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15858 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15861 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15862 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15863 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15864 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15865 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15866 function must return a formatted string.
15869 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15870 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15871 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15872 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15873 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15874 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15875 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15876 supplied instead of strings.
15879 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15880 @subsection Translator functions
15881 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15882 @cindex translator function
15884 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15885 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15886 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15887 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15888 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15889 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15890 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15891 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15892 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15896 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15897 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15898 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15899 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15902 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15903 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15904 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15905 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15906 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15910 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15911 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15912 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e., the
15913 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15914 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15915 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15916 overrule the default with
15919 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15922 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15923 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15924 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15925 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15926 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15927 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15931 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15932 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15936 Please check the documentation string of the function
15937 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15938 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15939 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15940 using the generic function.
15942 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15943 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15944 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15945 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15946 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15947 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15948 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15949 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15950 others can benefit from your work.
15952 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15953 @subsection Radio lists
15954 @cindex radio lists
15955 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15957 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15958 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15959 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15960 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15962 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15966 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15968 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15970 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15973 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15976 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15981 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15982 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15984 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15993 Pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
15994 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
15996 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
15997 @section Dynamic blocks
15998 @cindex dynamic blocks
16000 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16001 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16002 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16003 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16005 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16006 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16007 the content of the block.
16009 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16011 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16016 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16019 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16020 Update dynamic block at point.
16021 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16022 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16025 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16026 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16027 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16028 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16029 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16031 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16032 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16033 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16034 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16038 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16044 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16047 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16048 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16049 (insert "Last block update at: "
16050 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16053 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16054 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16055 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16056 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16059 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16060 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16062 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16063 @section Special agenda views
16064 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16066 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16067 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16068 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16069 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16070 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16071 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16072 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16073 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16074 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16075 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16076 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16078 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16079 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16080 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16081 PROJECT@. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16082 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16083 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16085 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16086 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16087 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16088 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16089 search should continue from there.
16092 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16093 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16094 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16095 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16096 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16097 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16100 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16104 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16105 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16106 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16107 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16110 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16111 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16112 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16114 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16115 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16116 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16117 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16118 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16119 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16120 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16121 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16122 you really want to have.
16124 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16125 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16126 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16129 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16130 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16131 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16132 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16133 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16134 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16135 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16136 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16137 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16138 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16139 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16140 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16141 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16142 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16143 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16144 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16145 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16146 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16147 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16148 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16149 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16152 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16153 like this, even without defining a special function:
16156 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16157 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16158 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16159 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16160 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16163 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16164 @section Extracting agenda information
16165 @cindex agenda, pipe
16166 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16168 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16169 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16170 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16171 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16172 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16173 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16174 ASCII text to STDOUT@. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16175 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16176 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16177 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16178 current TODO list, you could use
16181 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16184 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16185 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16186 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16187 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16190 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16191 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16195 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16198 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16199 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16200 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16201 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16202 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16207 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16208 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16210 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16211 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16212 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16213 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16217 category @r{The category of the item}
16218 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16219 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16220 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16221 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16222 diary @r{imported from diary}
16223 deadline @r{a deadline}
16224 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16225 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16226 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16227 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16228 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16229 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16230 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16231 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16232 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16233 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16234 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16235 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16236 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16240 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16241 led to the selection of the item.
16243 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16244 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16245 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16250 # define the Emacs command to run
16251 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16253 # run it and capture the output
16254 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16256 # loop over all lines
16257 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16258 # get the individual values
16259 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16260 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16261 # process and print
16262 print "[ ] $head\n";
16266 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16267 @section Using the property API
16268 @cindex API, for properties
16269 @cindex properties, API
16271 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16274 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16275 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16276 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16277 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16278 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16279 if the property key was used several times.@*
16280 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16281 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16282 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16284 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16285 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16286 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16287 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM@. By default,
16288 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16289 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16290 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16291 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16292 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16295 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16296 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16299 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16300 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16303 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16304 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16307 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16308 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16311 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16312 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES@. VALUES should be a list of
16313 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16316 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16317 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16318 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16321 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16322 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16323 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16326 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16327 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16328 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16331 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16332 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16333 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16336 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16337 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16338 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16339 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16340 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16341 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16342 responsible for this property.
16345 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16346 @section Using the mapping API
16347 @cindex API, for mapping
16348 @cindex mapping entries, API
16350 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16351 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16352 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16353 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16356 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16357 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16359 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16360 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16361 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16362 returned as a list.
16364 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16365 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16366 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16367 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16368 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16369 if you have removed (e.g., archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16370 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16371 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16372 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16375 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16376 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16377 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16378 visited by the iteration.
16380 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16383 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16384 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16385 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16386 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16388 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16389 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16390 agenda-with-archives
16391 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16393 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16396 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16397 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16399 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16401 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16402 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16403 function or Lisp form
16404 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16405 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16406 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16407 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16411 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16412 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16413 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16414 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16416 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16417 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16418 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16421 @defun org-priority &optional action
16422 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16423 possible values for ACTION.
16426 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16427 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16428 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16432 Promote the current entry.
16436 Demote the current entry.
16439 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16440 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16441 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16445 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16446 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16449 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16450 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16453 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16456 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16457 @appendix MobileOrg
16461 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16462 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16463 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16464 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16465 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16466 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16467 Moreland. Android users should check out
16468 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16469 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16472 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16473 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16474 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16476 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16477 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16478 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16479 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16480 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16481 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16482 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16485 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16486 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16487 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16490 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16491 @section Setting up the staging area
16493 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16494 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16495 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16496 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16497 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16498 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16499 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16500 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16501 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16502 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16503 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16505 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16506 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16507 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16508 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16509 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16510 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16511 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16515 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16518 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16519 and to read captured notes from there.
16521 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16522 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16524 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16525 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16526 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16527 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16528 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16529 inside this directory@footnote{Symbolic links in @code{org-directory} need to
16530 have the same name than their targets.}.
16532 The push operation also creates a special Org file @file{agendas.org} with
16533 all custom agenda view defined by the user@footnote{While creating the
16534 agendas, Org mode will force ID properties on all referenced entries, so that
16535 these entries can be uniquely identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for
16536 further action. If you do not want to get these properties in so many
16537 entries, you can set the variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}
16538 to @code{nil}. Org mode will then rely on outline paths, in the hope that
16539 these will be unique enough.}.
16541 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16542 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16543 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16544 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16545 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16547 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16548 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16550 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16551 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16552 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16553 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16554 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16558 Org moves all entries found in
16559 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16560 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16561 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16562 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16564 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16565 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16566 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16567 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16568 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16569 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16570 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16571 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16573 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16574 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16575 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16576 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16581 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16582 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16583 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16584 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16585 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16586 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16587 this flagged entry is finished.
16592 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16593 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16594 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16595 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16596 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16597 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16598 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16600 @node History and Acknowledgments, GNU Free Documentation License, MobileOrg, Top
16601 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16602 @cindex acknowledgments
16606 @section From Carsten
16608 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16609 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16610 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16611 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16612 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16613 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16614 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16615 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16616 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16617 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16618 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16619 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16620 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16621 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16622 functionality directly into a notes file.
16624 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16625 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16626 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16627 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16628 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16629 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16630 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16633 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16636 @item Bastien Guerry
16637 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16638 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16639 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16640 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16641 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16642 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16643 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16644 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16645 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16646 programming and reproducible research.
16648 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16649 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16650 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16651 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16652 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16653 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16654 @item Sebastian Rose
16655 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16656 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16657 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16658 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16659 single-key navigation.
16662 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
16663 let me know what I am missing here!
16665 @section From Bastien
16667 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
16668 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
16669 to Carsten's ones above.
16671 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
16672 maintainership of Org. His support as been great since day one of this new
16673 adventure, and it helped a lot.
16675 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
16676 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
16677 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
16678 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
16679 either of the code or the community:
16683 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
16684 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
16686 @item Nicolas Goaziou
16687 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
16688 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el} has been outstanding, and
16689 opened the doors for many new ideas and features.
16691 @item Jambunathan K
16692 Jambunathan contributed the ODT exporter, definitely a killer feature of
16693 Org mode. He also contributed the new HTML exporter, which is another core
16694 feature of Org. Here too, I knew I could rely on him to fix bugs in these
16695 areas and to patiently explain the users what was the problems and solutions.
16698 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
16699 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
16700 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
16703 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
16704 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
16705 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
16708 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
16709 fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be
16710 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
16712 @section List of contributions
16717 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16719 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16721 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16724 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16726 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16728 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16730 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16732 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16733 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16735 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16738 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16739 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16740 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16742 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16744 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16746 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16747 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16750 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16752 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16753 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16754 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16756 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16757 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16759 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16760 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16761 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16763 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16766 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16768 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16770 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16771 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16773 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16775 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16777 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16779 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16782 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16783 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16785 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16787 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16789 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16791 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16794 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16795 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16796 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16798 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16801 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16803 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16804 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16806 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16808 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16810 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16811 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16813 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16814 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16816 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16817 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16818 small fixes and patches.
16820 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16822 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16824 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16827 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16830 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16832 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16833 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16835 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16837 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16839 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16840 file links, and TAGS.
16842 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16843 version of the reference card.
16845 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16848 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16850 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16851 links, among other things.
16853 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16854 provided frequent feedback.
16856 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16857 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16859 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16861 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16864 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16865 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16867 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16869 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16870 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16872 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16875 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16876 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16878 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16881 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16883 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16884 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16886 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16887 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16889 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16890 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16892 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16895 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16897 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16898 tweaks and features.
16900 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16901 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16903 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16904 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16906 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16907 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16909 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16910 chapter about publishing.
16912 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16914 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16915 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16917 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16918 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16919 concept index for HTML export.
16921 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16924 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16926 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16929 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16932 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16935 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16938 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16939 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16943 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Main Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16944 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
16945 @include doclicense.texi
16948 @node Main Index, Key Index, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
16949 @unnumbered Concept index
16953 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16954 @unnumbered Key index
16958 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16959 @unnumbered Command and function index
16963 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16964 @unnumbered Variable index
16966 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16967 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16968 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16974 @c Local variables:
16976 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16977 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16978 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16982 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre